blob: d3f049eab70f0445301c558024e0f0ff05c471db [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
778 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200780maxconnrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100790maxcomprate <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300792 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100793 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
794 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
795 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
796 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
797 default value.
798
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100799maxcompcpuusage <number>
800 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
801 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
802 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
803 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
804 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
805 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
806 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
807 process down and from introducing high latencies.
808
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100809maxpipes <number>
810 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
811 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
812 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
813 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
814 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
815 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
816
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200817maxsessrate <number>
818 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
819 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
820 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
821 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
822 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
823 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
824 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
825 fairness.
826
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200827maxsslconn <number>
828 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
829 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
830 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
831 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
832 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
833 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
834 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
835
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200836maxsslrate <number>
837 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
838 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
839 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
840 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
841 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
842 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
843 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
844 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
845 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
846 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
847
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100848maxzlibmem <number>
849 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
850 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
851 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100852 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
853 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
854 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856noepoll
857 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
858 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100859 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
861nokqueue
862 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
863 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
864 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
865
866nopoll
867 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
868 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100869 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100872nosplice
873 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
874 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
875 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100876 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100877 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
878 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
879 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
880 "option splice-response".
881
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300882nogetaddrinfo
883 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
884 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
885
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200886spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900887 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
888 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
889 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
890 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
891 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
892 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200893
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100894tune.buffers.reserve <number>
895 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
896 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
897 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
898 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
899
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900tune.bufsize <number>
901 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
902 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
903 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
904 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
905 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
906 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
907 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
908 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400909 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
910 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
911 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200912
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200913tune.chksize <number>
914 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
915 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
916 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
917 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
918 checks whenever possible.
919
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100920tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
921 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
922 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
923 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
924 this value. The default value is 1.
925
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100926tune.http.cookielen <number>
927 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
928 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
929 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
930 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
931 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
932 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
933 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
934 to change this value.
935
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200936tune.http.maxhdr <number>
937 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
938 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
939 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
940 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
941 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
942 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
943 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
944 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
945 limit too high.
946
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100947tune.idletimer <timeout>
948 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
949 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
950 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
951 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
952 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
953 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
954 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
955 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
956 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
957
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100958tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100959 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
960 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
961 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
962 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
963 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
964 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
965 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
966 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
967 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
968 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100969
970tune.maxpollevents <number>
971 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
972 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
973 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
974 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
975 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
976
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200977tune.maxrewrite <number>
978 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
979 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
980 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
981 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
982 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
983 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
984 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
985 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
986 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
987 bufsize.
988
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200989tune.pipesize <number>
990 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
991 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
992 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
993 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
994 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
995 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
996
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100997tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
998tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
999 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1000 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1001 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1002 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1003 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1004 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1005 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1006
1007tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1008tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1009 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1010 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1011 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1012 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1013 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1014 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1015 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1016 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1017 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1018 notifying haproxy again.
1019
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001021 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1022 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1023 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001024 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001025 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1026 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1027 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1028 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1029 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001030 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1031 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001032
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001033tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1034 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1035 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1036 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1037 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1038 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1039 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1040
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001041tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1042 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001043 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001044 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1045 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1046 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1047 being used for too long.
1048
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001049tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1050 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1051 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1052 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1053 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1054 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1055 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1056 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1057 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1058 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1059 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001060 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1061 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001062
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001063tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1064 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1065 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1066 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1067 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1068 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1069 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1070 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1071 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1072
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001073tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1074 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001075 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001076 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1077 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1078 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1079
1080tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1081 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1082 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1083 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1084 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010863.3. Debugging
1087--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
1089debug
1090 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1091 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1092 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1093 system startup.
1094
1095quiet
1096 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1097 line argument "-q".
1098
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011003.4. Userlists
1101--------------
1102It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1103http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1104it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1105
1106userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001108 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1109
1110group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001111 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001112 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1113 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1114
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001115user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1116 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1118 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001119 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1120 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001122 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001123
1124
1125 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 userlist L1
1127 group G1 users tiger,scott
1128 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001130 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1131 user scott insecure-password elgato
1132 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001133
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001134 userlist L2
1135 group G1
1136 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001137
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001138 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1139 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1140 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001141
1142 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001143
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001144
11453.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001146----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001147It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1148haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1149pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1150identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1151or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1152Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1153known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1154the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1155process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1156during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1157tables.
1158
1159peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001160 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001161 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1162
1163peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1164 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1165 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1166 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1167 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1168 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1169 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1170
1171 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1172 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1173
1174 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1175 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1176 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1177 across all peers.
1178
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001179 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1180 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1181 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1182
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001183 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001184 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001185 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1186 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1187 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001188
1189 backend mybackend
1190 mode tcp
1191 balance roundrobin
1192 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1193 stick on src
1194
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001195 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1196 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001197
1198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011994. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001201
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001202Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1203 - defaults <name>
1204 - frontend <name>
1205 - backend <name>
1206 - listen <name>
1207
1208A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1209its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1210section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001211section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001212
1213A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1214connections.
1215
1216A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1217to forward incoming connections.
1218
1219A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1220parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001222All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1223'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1224case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1225
1226Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1227logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1228proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1229However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1230name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1231
1232Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1233and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001234bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001235protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1236modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1237arbitrary criteria.
1238
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001239In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1240a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1241the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1242
1243 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1244 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1245 between responses and new requests.
1246
1247 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1248 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1249 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1250 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1251
1252 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1253 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1254 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1255
1256 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1257 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1258 client-facing connection remains open.
1259
1260 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1261 after the end of the response.
1262
1263The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1264frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1265following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1266weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1267
1268 Backend mode
1269
1270 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1271 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1272 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1273 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1274 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1275 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1276 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1277 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1278 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1279 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1280 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012844.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1285--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001287The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1288limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1289they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1290limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001291marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001292option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001293and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1294with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1295specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001297
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001298 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1299------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1300acl - X X X
1301appsession - - X X
1302backlog X X X -
1303balance X - X X
1304bind - X X -
1305bind-process X X X X
1306block - X X X
1307capture cookie - X X -
1308capture request header - X X -
1309capture response header - X X -
1310clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001311compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001312contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1313cookie X - X X
1314default-server X - X X
1315default_backend X X X -
1316description - X X X
1317disabled X X X X
1318dispatch - - X X
1319enabled X X X X
1320errorfile X X X X
1321errorloc X X X X
1322errorloc302 X X X X
1323-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1324errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001325force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326fullconn X - X X
1327grace X X X X
1328hash-type X - X X
1329http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001330http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001331http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001332http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001333http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001334http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001335id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001336ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001337log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001338max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001339maxconn X X X -
1340mode X X X X
1341monitor fail - X X -
1342monitor-net X X X -
1343monitor-uri X X X -
1344option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1345option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1346option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1347option allbackups (*) X - X X
1348option checkcache (*) X - X X
1349option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1350option contstats (*) X X X -
1351option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1352option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1353option forceclose (*) X X X X
1354-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1355option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001356option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001357option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001358option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001359option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001360option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001361option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1362option httpchk X - X X
1363option httpclose (*) X X X X
1364option httplog X X X X
1365option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001366option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001367option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001368option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001369option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1370option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1371option logasap (*) X X X -
1372option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001373option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001374option nolinger (*) X X X X
1375option originalto X X X X
1376option persist (*) X - X X
1377option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001378option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001379option smtpchk X - X X
1380option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1381option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1382option splice-request (*) X X X X
1383option splice-response (*) X X X X
1384option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1385option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1386-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001387option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001388option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1389option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1390option tcpka X X X X
1391option tcplog X X X X
1392option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001393external-check command X - X X
1394external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001395persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1396rate-limit sessions X X X -
1397redirect - X X X
1398redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1399redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1400reqadd - X X X
1401reqallow - X X X
1402reqdel - X X X
1403reqdeny - X X X
1404reqiallow - X X X
1405reqidel - X X X
1406reqideny - X X X
1407reqipass - X X X
1408reqirep - X X X
1409reqisetbe - X X X
1410reqitarpit - X X X
1411reqpass - X X X
1412reqrep - X X X
1413-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1414reqsetbe - X X X
1415reqtarpit - X X X
1416retries X - X X
1417rspadd - X X X
1418rspdel - X X X
1419rspdeny - X X X
1420rspidel - X X X
1421rspideny - X X X
1422rspirep - X X X
1423rsprep - X X X
1424server - - X X
1425source X - X X
1426srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001427stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001428stats auth X - X X
1429stats enable X - X X
1430stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001431stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001432stats realm X - X X
1433stats refresh X - X X
1434stats scope X - X X
1435stats show-desc X - X X
1436stats show-legends X - X X
1437stats show-node X - X X
1438stats uri X - X X
1439-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1440stick match - - X X
1441stick on - - X X
1442stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001443stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001444stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001445tcp-check connect - - X X
1446tcp-check expect - - X X
1447tcp-check send - - X X
1448tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001449tcp-request connection - X X -
1450tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001451tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001452tcp-response content - - X X
1453tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001454timeout check X - X X
1455timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001456timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001457timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1458timeout connect X - X X
1459timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1460timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1461timeout http-request X X X X
1462timeout queue X - X X
1463timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001464timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001465timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1466timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001467timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001468transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001469unique-id-format X X X -
1470unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001471use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001472use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001473------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1474 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014774.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1478---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1481
1482
1483acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1484 Declare or complete an access list.
1485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1486 no | yes | yes | yes
1487 Example:
1488 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1489 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1490 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001492 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001493
1494
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001495appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1496 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001497 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1499 no | no | yes | yes
1500 Arguments :
1501 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1502 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1503
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001504 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001505 checked in each cookie value.
1506
1507 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1508 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1509 milliseconds.
1510
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001511 request-learn
1512 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1513 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1514 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1515 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1516 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1517 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1518
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001519 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1520 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1521 data following this prefix.
1522
1523 Example :
1524 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1525
1526 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1527 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1528
1529 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1530 2 modes are currently supported :
1531 - path-parameters :
1532 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1533 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1534 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1535 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1536 - query-string :
1537 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1538 query string.
1539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001540 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1541 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1542 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1543 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001544 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1545 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1546 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1548 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1549
1550 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1551
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001552 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1553 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1554 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556 Example :
1557 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1558
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001559 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1560 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561
1562
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001563backlog <conns>
1564 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1566 yes | yes | yes | no
1567 Arguments :
1568 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1569 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001570 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001571
1572 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1573 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1574 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1575 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1576 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1577 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1578 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1579 backlog parameter.
1580
1581 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1582 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1583 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1584
1585 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1586
1587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001588balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001589balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1592 yes | no | yes | yes
1593 Arguments :
1594 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1595 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1596 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1597 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1598
1599 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1600 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1601 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1602 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001603 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001604 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001605 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1606 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1607 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1608 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1609 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1610 it, so that you don't worry.
1611
1612 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1613 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1614 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1615 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1616 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1617 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1618 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1619 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001621 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1622 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1623 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1624 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1625 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1626 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1627 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1628 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1629
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001630 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001631 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001632 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1633 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001634 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001635 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1636 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1637 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1638 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1639 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001640 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1641 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1642 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1643 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1644 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1645 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001646
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001647 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1648 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1649 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1650 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1651 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1652 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1653 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1654 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001655 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001656 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001657 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1658 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1659 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001660
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001661 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1662 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1663 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1664 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1665 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1666 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1667 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1668 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1669 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1670 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1671 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1672 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001673
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001674 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001675 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1676 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1677 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1678 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1679 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1680 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1681 URIs start with a leading "/".
1682
1683 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1684 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1685 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1686 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001688 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001689 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1690
1691 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001692 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1693 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001694 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1695 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1696 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1697 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001698 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001699 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1700 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001701
1702 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1703 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1704 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1705 server will receive the request.
1706
1707 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1708 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1709 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1710 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1711 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001712 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1713 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1714 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001716 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1717 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1718 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1719 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1720 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001722 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001723 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1724 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1725 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1726
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001727 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1728 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1729 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1730
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001731 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001732 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001733 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1734 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1735 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1736 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1737 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1738 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001739 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001740 used instead.
1741
1742 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1743 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1744 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1745 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1746
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001747 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1748 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1749 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1750
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001751 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001753 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001754 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1755 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001756
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001757 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1758 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1759 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760
1761 Examples :
1762 balance roundrobin
1763 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001764 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001765 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1766 balance hdr(host)
1767 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001768
1769 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1770 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001772 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001773 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1774 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1775 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1776 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1777
1778 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1779 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1780 defaults to 16 kB.
1781
1782 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1783 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1784
1785 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1786 Round Robin.
1787
1788 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1789 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1790 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1791 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1792
1793 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1794
1795 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001796 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001797 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1798 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1799 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001801 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1802 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803
1804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001805bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1806bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1809 no | yes | yes | no
1810 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001811 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1812 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1813 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1814 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001815 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001816 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1817 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1818 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1819 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1820 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1821 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1822 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001823 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1824 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1825 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1826 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1827 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1828 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1829 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001830 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1831 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1832 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001833 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1834 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1835 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1836 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001837
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001838 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1839 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001840 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1841 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1842 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001843 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1844 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1845 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1846 the range.
1847
1848 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1849 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1850 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1851 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1852 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1853 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1854 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001855 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001856 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001858 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1859 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1860 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1861 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1862 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1863 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1864 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1865 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1866
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001867 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1868 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1869 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1870 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001872 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1873 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1874 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1875 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1876 in a frontend.
1877
1878 Example :
1879 listen http_proxy
1880 bind :80,:443
1881 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001882 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001884 listen http_https_proxy
1885 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001886 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001887
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001888 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1889 bind ipv6@:80
1890 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1891 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1892
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001893 listen external_bind_app1
1894 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1895
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001896 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001897 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898
1899
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001900bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001901 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1903 yes | yes | yes | yes
1904 Arguments :
1905 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1906 may be used to override a default value.
1907
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001908 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001909 option may be combined with other numbers.
1910
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001911 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001912 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1913 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1914 missing from all processes.
1915
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001916 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001917 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001918 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1919 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1920 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1921 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001922
1923 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1924 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1925 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1926 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1927 and 'even' instances.
1928
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001929 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1930 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1931 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1932 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001933
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001934 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1935 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1936
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001937 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1938 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1939 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1940
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001941 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1942 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1943
1944 Example :
1945 listen app_ip1
1946 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001947 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001948
1949 listen app_ip2
1950 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001951 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001952
1953 listen management
1954 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001955 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001956
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001957 listen management
1958 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1959 bind-process 1-4
1960
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001961 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001962
1963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001964block { if | unless } <condition>
1965 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1967 no | yes | yes | yes
1968
1969 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1970 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001971 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001972 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1974 "block" statements per instance.
1975
1976 Example:
1977 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1978 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1979 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1980 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001982 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983
1984
1985capture cookie <name> len <length>
1986 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1988 no | yes | yes | no
1989 Arguments :
1990 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1991 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1992 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1993 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1994 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1995
1996 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1997 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1998 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1999 right if it exceeds <length>.
2000
2001 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2002 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2003 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2004 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2005
2006 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2007 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2008 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2009
2010 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2011 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2012 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002013 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2014 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2015 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
2017 Example:
2018 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2019
2020 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002021 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002022
2023
2024capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002025 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2027 no | yes | yes | no
2028 Arguments :
2029 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002030 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2032 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2033 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2034
2035 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2036 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2037 it exceeds <length>.
2038
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002039 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2041 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002042 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2043 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2044 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2045 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002046 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002047 environments to find where the request came from.
2048
2049 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2050 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2051 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2052 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002054 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2055 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2056 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2057 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2058 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059
2060 Example:
2061 capture request header Host len 15
2062 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2063 capture request header Referrer len 15
2064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002065 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066 about logging.
2067
2068
2069capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002070 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2072 no | yes | yes | no
2073 Arguments :
2074 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002075 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002076 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2077 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2078 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2079
2080 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2081 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2082 it exceeds <length>.
2083
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002084 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2086 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2087 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002088 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2089 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2090 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2091 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002093 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2094 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2095 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2096 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2097 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098
2099 Example:
2100 capture response header Content-length len 9
2101 capture response header Location len 15
2102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002103 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104 about logging.
2105
2106
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002107clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2110 yes | yes | yes | no
2111 Arguments :
2112 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2113 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2114 as explained at the top of this document.
2115
2116 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2117 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2118 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2119 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2120 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2121 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2122 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2123 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002124 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002125 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2126 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2127
2128 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2129 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2130 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2131 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2132 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2133 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2134
2135 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2136 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2137
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002138 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2139 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002141compression algo <algorithm> ...
2142compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002143compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002144 Enable HTTP compression.
2145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2146 yes | yes | yes | yes
2147 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002148 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2149 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2150 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2151
2152 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002153 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002154 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2155 data.
2156
2157 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2158 support for zlib was built in.
2159
2160 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2161 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2162 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2163 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2164 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2165 in.
2166
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002167 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002168 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002169 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2170 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2171 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2172 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2173 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002174
2175 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2176 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2177 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2178 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2179 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002180 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2181 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2182 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2183 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2184 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002185 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2186 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002187
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002188 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002189 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2190 "Accept-Encoding" header
2191 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002192 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002193 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2194 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002195 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2196 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2197 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2198 "multipart"
2199 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2200 header
2201 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2202 and later
2203 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2204 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002205
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002206 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2207 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002208
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002209 Examples :
2210 compression algo gzip
2211 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002212
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002213contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2216 yes | no | yes | yes
2217 Arguments :
2218 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2219 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2220 as explained at the top of this document.
2221
2222 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002223 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002224 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002225 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2226 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2227 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2228 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2229
2230 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2231 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2232 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2233 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2234 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2235 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2236
2237 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2238 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2239 instead.
2240
2241 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2242 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2243
2244
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002245cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002246 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2247 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002248 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2250 yes | no | yes | yes
2251 Arguments :
2252 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2253 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2254 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2255 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2256 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2257 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2258 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2259 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2260 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2261
2262 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2263 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2264 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2265 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2266 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2267 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2268 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2269 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2270 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2271 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2272 "insert" and "prefix".
2273
2274 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002275 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002276
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002277 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002278 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2279 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2280 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2281 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2282 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2283 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2284 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2285 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2286 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2287 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
2289 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2290 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2291 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2292 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2293 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2294 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2295 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2296 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2297 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2298 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002299 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2300 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2301 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002303 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2304 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2305 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002306 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2307 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2308 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2309 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002310 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2311 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2312 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313
2314 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2315 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2316 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2317 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2318 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2319 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2320 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2321 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2322 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2323
2324 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2325 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2326 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2327 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2328 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2329 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2330 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2331 persistence cookie in the cache.
2332 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2333
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002334 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2335 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2336 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2337 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2338 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2339 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2340 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2341 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2342 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2343 they logout.
2344
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002345 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2346 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2347 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2348 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2349
2350 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2351 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2352 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2353 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2354 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2355 this attribute.
2356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002357 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002358 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002359 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2360 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2361 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2362 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2363 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2364 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002365
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002366 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2367 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2368 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2369 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2370 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2371 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2372 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2373 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2374 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2375 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2376 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2377 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2378 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2379 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2380 the site.
2381
2382 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2383 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2384 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2385 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2386 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2387 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2388 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2389 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2390 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2391 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2392 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2393 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2394 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2395 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2396 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2397 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2400 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2401 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2402 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 Examples :
2405 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2406 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2407 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002408 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002410 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002411 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002412
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002414default-server [param*]
2415 Change default options for a server in a backend
2416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2417 yes | no | yes | yes
2418 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002419 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2420 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2421 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2422 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002423
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002424 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002425 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2426
2427 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430default_backend <backend>
2431 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2433 yes | yes | yes | no
2434 Arguments :
2435 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2436
2437 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2438 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2439 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2440 will catch all undetermined requests.
2441
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 Example :
2443
2444 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2445 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2446 default_backend dynamic
2447
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002448 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002451description <string>
2452 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2454 no | yes | yes | yes
2455 Arguments : string
2456
2457 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2458 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2459 it describes.
2460 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2461
2462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002463disabled
2464 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2466 yes | yes | yes | yes
2467 Arguments : none
2468
2469 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2470 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2471 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2472 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2473 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2474 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2475 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2476
2477 See also : "enabled"
2478
2479
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002480dispatch <address>:<port>
2481 Set a default server address
2482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2483 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002484 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002485
2486 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2487 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2488 during start-up.
2489
2490 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2491 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2492 possible with normal servers.
2493
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002494 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002495 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2496 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2497 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2498 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2499
2500 See also : "server"
2501
2502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503enabled
2504 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2506 yes | yes | yes | yes
2507 Arguments : none
2508
2509 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2510 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2511
2512 See also : "disabled"
2513
2514
2515errorfile <code> <file>
2516 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2518 yes | yes | yes | yes
2519 Arguments :
2520 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002521 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522
2523 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002524 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002525 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002526 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2527 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002528
2529 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2530 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2531 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2532
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002533 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2536 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2537 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2538 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2539
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002540 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2541 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2542 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2543 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2544 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2545 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2546
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2548 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2549 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002550 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2552
2553 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2554
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002555 Example :
2556 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002557 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002558 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2559 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002561
2562errorloc <code> <url>
2563errorloc302 <code> <url>
2564 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 yes | yes | yes | yes
2567 Arguments :
2568 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002569 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002570
2571 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2572 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2573 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2574 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2575 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2576
2577 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2578 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2579 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2580
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002581 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2582
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2584 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2585 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2586 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2587 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2588 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2589 request.
2590
2591 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2592
2593
2594errorloc303 <code> <url>
2595 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2597 yes | yes | yes | yes
2598 Arguments :
2599 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2600 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2601
2602 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2603 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2604 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2605 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2606 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2607
2608 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2609 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2610 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2611
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002612 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2615 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2616 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2617 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002618 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002619
2620 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2621
2622
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002623force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2624 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2625 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 no | yes | yes | yes
2627
2628 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2629 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2630 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2631 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2632 marked down for maintenance operations.
2633
2634 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2635 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2636 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2637 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2638 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2639 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2640 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2641 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2642 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2643
2644 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2645 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2646 is used.
2647
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002648 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002649 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002650
2651
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002652fullconn <conns>
2653 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2655 yes | no | yes | yes
2656 Arguments :
2657 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2658 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2659
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002660 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002661 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002662 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002663 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2664 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2665 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2666 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2667 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002668 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002669
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002670 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2671 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002672 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2673 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2674 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002675
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002676 Example :
2677 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2678 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2679 # connections.
2680 backend dynamic
2681 fullconn 10000
2682 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2683 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2684
2685 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2686
2687
2688grace <time>
2689 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002691 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002692 Arguments :
2693 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2694 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2695 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2696
2697 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2698 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002699 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002700 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2701
2702 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2703 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2704 simplify it.
2705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002707hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002708 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2710 yes | no | yes | yes
2711 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002712 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2713 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002714
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002715 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2716 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2717 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2718 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2719 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2720 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2721 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2722 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2723 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2724 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002725
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002726 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2727 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2728 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2729 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2730 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2731 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2732 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2733 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2734 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2735 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2736 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2737 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2738 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002739 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2740 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002741
2742 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2743
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002744 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002745 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2746 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2747 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002748 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2749 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2750 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002751
2752 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2753 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002754 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2755 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2756 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2757 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2758
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002759 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2760 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2761 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2762 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2763 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2764 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2765 parameter.
2766
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002767 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2768
2769 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2770 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2771 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2772 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2773 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2774 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2775 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2776 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2777 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2778 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2779 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2780 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002781
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002782 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2783 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2784 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002785
2786 See also : "balance", "server"
2787
2788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002789http-check disable-on-404
2790 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002792 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793 Arguments : none
2794
2795 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2796 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2797 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2798 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2799 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2800 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2801 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2802 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002803 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2804 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2805 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2806
2807 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2808
2809
2810http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002811 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002813 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002814 Arguments :
2815 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2816 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002817 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002818 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2819 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2820 details on the supported keywords.
2821
2822 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2823 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2824 with the usual backslash ('\').
2825
2826 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2827 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2828 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2829 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2830 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2831
2832 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002833 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002834 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2835 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2836 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2837
2838 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002839 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002840 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2841 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2842 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2843 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2844
2845 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002846 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002847 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2848 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2849 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2850 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2851 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2852 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2853 trace).
2854
2855 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002856 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002857 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2858 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2859 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2860 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2861 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2862 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2863
2864 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2865 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2866 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2867 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2868 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2869 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2870 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2871 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2872
2873 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2874 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2875
2876 Examples :
2877 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002878 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002879
2880 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002881 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002882
2883 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002884 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002885
2886 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002887 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002889 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002890
2891
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002892http-check send-state
2893 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2895 yes | no | yes | yes
2896 Arguments : none
2897
2898 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2899 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2900 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2901 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2902 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2903
2904 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2905 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2906 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2907 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2908 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2909 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2910 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2911 checked in multiple backends.
2912
2913 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2914 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2915
2916 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2917 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2918 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2919 one fails.
2920
2921 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2922 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2923 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2924
2925 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2926 server's queue.
2927
2928 Example of a header received by the application server :
2929 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2930 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2931
2932 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2933
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002934http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002935 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002936 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002937 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2938 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002939 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2940 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2941 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2942 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02002943 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
2944 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002945 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002946 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002947 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2948
2949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2950 no | yes | yes | yes
2951
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002952 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2953 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2954 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2955 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2956 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002957
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002958 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2959 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2960 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2961
2962 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2963 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2964 are evaluated.
2965
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002966 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2967 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2968 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2969 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2970 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2971 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2972 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2973 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2974 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002975 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002976 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2977
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002978 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2979 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2980 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2981 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2982 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2983
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002984 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2985 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2986 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002987 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2988 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002989
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002990 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2991 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2992 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2993 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2994 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2995 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2996 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2997 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2998
2999 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3000 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3001 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3002 external users.
3003
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003004 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3005 <name>.
3006
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003007 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3008 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3009 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3010 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3011 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3012 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3013 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3014 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3015
3016 Example:
3017
3018 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3019
3020 applied to:
3021
3022 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3023
3024 outputs:
3025
3026 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3027
3028 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3029
3030 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3031 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3032 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3033 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3034 header.
3035
3036 Example:
3037
3038 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3039
3040 applied to:
3041
3042 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3043
3044 outputs:
3045
3046 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3047
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003048 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3049 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3050 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3051 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3052 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3053 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3054 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3055 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3056
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003057 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3058 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3059 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3060 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3061 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3062 another equipment.
3063
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003064 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3065 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3066 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3067 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3068 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3069 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3070 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3071 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3072
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003073 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3074 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3075 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3076 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3077 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3078 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3079 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3080 admin privileges.
3081
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003082 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3083 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3084 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3085 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3086 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3087 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3088 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3089 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3090
3091 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3092 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3093 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3094 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3095 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3096 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3097
3098 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3099 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3100 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3101 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3102 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3103 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3104
3105 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3106 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3107 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3108 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3109 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3110 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3111 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3112 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3113 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3114
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003115 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3116 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3117 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3118 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3119 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3120 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3121 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3122 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3123 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3124 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3125 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3126 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3127
3128 These actions take one or two arguments :
3129 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3130 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3131 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3132 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3133
3134 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3135 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3136 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3137 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3138
3139 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3140 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3141 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3142 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3143 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3144 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3145 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3146 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3147
3148 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3149 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3150 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3151 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3152 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3153
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003154 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3155
3156 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3157 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3158 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3159 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003160
3161 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003162 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3163 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3164 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003165
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003166 http-request allow if nagios
3167 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3168 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3169 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003170
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003171 Example:
3172 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003173 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003174
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003175 Example:
3176 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3177 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3178 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3179 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3180 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3181 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3182 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3183 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3184 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3185
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003186 Example:
3187 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3188 acl add path /addacl
3189 acl del path /delacl
3190
3191 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3192
3193 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3194 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3195
3196 Example:
3197 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3198 acl setmap path /setmap
3199 acl delmap path /delmap
3200
3201 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3202
3203 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3204 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3205
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003206 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3207 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003208
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003209http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003210 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003211 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3212 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003213 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3214 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3215 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3216 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3217 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3218 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003219 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003220 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3221
3222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3223 no | yes | yes | yes
3224
3225 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3226 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3227 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3228 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3229 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3230 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3231
3232 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3233 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3234 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3235 current section.
3236
3237 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3238 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3239 rules are evaluated.
3240
3241 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3242 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3243 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3244 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3245 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3246 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3247 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3248
3249 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3250 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3251 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3252 external users.
3253
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003254 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3255 <name>.
3256
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003257 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3258 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3259 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3260 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3261 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3262 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3263 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3264 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3265
3266 Example:
3267
3268 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3269
3270 applied to:
3271
3272 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3273
3274 outputs:
3275
3276 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3277
3278 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3279
3280 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3281 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3282 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3283 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3284 header.
3285
3286 Example:
3287
3288 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3289
3290 applied to:
3291
3292 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3293
3294 outputs:
3295
3296 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3297
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003298 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3299 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3300 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3301 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3302 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3303 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3304 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3305 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3306
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003307 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3308 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3309 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3310 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3311 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3312 another equipment.
3313
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003314 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3315 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3316 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3317 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3318 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3319 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3320 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3321 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3322
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003323 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3324 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3325 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3326 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3327 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3328 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3329 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3330 admin privileges.
3331
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003332 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3333 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3334 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3335 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3336 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3337 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3338 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3339 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3340
3341 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3342 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3343 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3344 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3345 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3346 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3347
3348 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3349 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3350 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3351 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3352 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3353 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3354
3355 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3356 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3357 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3358 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3359 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3360 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3361 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3362 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3363 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3364
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003365 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3366
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003367 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003368 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3369 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3370 rules.
3371
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003372 Example:
3373 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3374
3375 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3376
3377 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3378 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3379
3380 Example:
3381 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3382
3383 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3384
3385 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3386 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3387
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003388 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3389 ACL usage.
3390
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003391
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003392http-send-name-header [<header>]
3393 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3394
3395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3396 yes | no | yes | yes
3397
3398 Arguments :
3399
3400 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3401
3402 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3403 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3404 is added with the header string proved.
3405
3406 See also : "server"
3407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003408id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003409 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3411 no | yes | yes | yes
3412 Arguments : none
3413
3414 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3415 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3416 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003417
3418
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003419ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3420 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3421 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3422 no | yes | yes | yes
3423
3424 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3425 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3426 and running).
3427
3428 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3429 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3430 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003431 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003432 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3433
3434 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3435 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3436
3437 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3438 "unless" condition is met.
3439
3440 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3441
3442
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003443log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003444log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003445no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003446 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3448 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003449
3450 Prefix :
3451 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3452 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3453 prefix does not allow arguments.
3454
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455 Arguments :
3456 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3457 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3458 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3459 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3460 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3461 parameter.
3462
3463 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3464 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3465
3466 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3467 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3468 standard syslog port).
3469
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003470 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3471 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3472 standard syslog port).
3473
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003474 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3475 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3476 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3477 appropriately writeable).
3478
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003479 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3480 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3481 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3482 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3483
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003484 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3485 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3486 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3487 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3488 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3489 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3490 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3491 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3492 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3493 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3494 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3495
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003496 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3497
3498 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3499 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3500 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3501
3502 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3503 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3504 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003505 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3506 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3507 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3508 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3509 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003510
3511 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3512
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003513 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3514 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3515 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003516
3517 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3518 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3519 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3520 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3521
3522 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3523 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003524
3525 Example :
3526 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003527 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3528 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003529 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003531
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003532log-format <string>
3533 Allows you to custom a log line.
3534
3535 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3536
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003537
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003538max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3539 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 yes | no | yes | yes
3542
3543 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3544 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3545 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3546 servers.
3547
3548 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3549 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3550 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3551 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3552 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3553 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3554 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3555 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3556 picking a different server.
3557
3558 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3559 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3560 even if they have to be queued.
3561
3562 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3563 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3564
3565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003566maxconn <conns>
3567 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 yes | yes | yes | no
3570 Arguments :
3571 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3572 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3573 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3574 closes.
3575
3576 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3577 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3578 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3579 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3580 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3581 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3582 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3583 properly tuned.
3584
3585 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3586 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3587 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3588
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003589 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3590
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003591 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3592
3593
3594mode { tcp|http|health }
3595 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3597 yes | yes | yes | yes
3598 Arguments :
3599 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3600 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3601 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3602 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3603
3604 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3605 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3606 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3607 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3608 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3609
3610 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003611 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3612 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3613 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3614 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3615 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3616 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3617 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003618
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3620 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3621 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003622
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003623 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003624 defaults http_instances
3625 mode http
3626
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003627 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003630monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3633 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634 Arguments :
3635 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3636 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003637 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3639 backend and its backup.
3640
3641 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3642 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3643 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3644 servers in a list of backends.
3645
3646 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3647 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3648 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3649 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3650 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3651 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3652 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003653 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3654 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
3656 Example:
3657 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003658 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003659 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3660 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3661 monitor-uri /site_alive
3662 monitor fail if site_dead
3663
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003664 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003665
3666
3667monitor-net <source>
3668 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 yes | yes | yes | no
3671 Arguments :
3672 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3673 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3674 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3675 followed by a mask.
3676
3677 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3678 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003679 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003680 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3681
3682 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3683 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3684 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3685 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003686 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3687 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3688 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003689
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003690 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3691 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3692 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3693 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3694 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3695 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003696
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003697 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3698 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003700 Example :
3701 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3702 frontend www
3703 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3704
3705 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3706
3707
3708monitor-uri <uri>
3709 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | yes | yes | no
3712 Arguments :
3713 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3714 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3715
3716 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3717 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3718 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3719 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3720 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3721 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3722 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3723 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3724
3725 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3726 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3727 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3728 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3729 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3730 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3731
3732 Example :
3733 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3734 frontend www
3735 mode http
3736 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3737
3738 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003740
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003741option abortonclose
3742no option abortonclose
3743 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3745 yes | no | yes | yes
3746 Arguments : none
3747
3748 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3749 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3750 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3751 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003752 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003753 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3754 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3755 encountered while delivering the response.
3756
3757 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3758 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3759 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3760 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3761 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3762 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003763 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003764 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003765 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003766 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3767 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3768 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3769
3770 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3771 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3772 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3773 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3774 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3775 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3776 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3777 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003778 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003779
3780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3782
3783 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3784
3785
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003786option accept-invalid-http-request
3787no option accept-invalid-http-request
3788 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | no
3791 Arguments : none
3792
3793 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3794 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3795 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3796 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3797 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3798 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3799 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3800 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003801 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3802 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3803 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3804 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3805 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3806 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003807
3808 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3809 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3810 been confirmed.
3811
3812 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3813 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003814 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3815 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003816 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3817
3818 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3819 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3820
3821 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3822 stats socket.
3823
3824
3825option accept-invalid-http-response
3826no option accept-invalid-http-response
3827 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | no | yes | yes
3830 Arguments : none
3831
3832 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3833 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3834 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3835 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3836 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3837 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3838 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3839 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3840 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3841
3842 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3843 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3844 been confirmed.
3845
3846 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3847 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3848 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3849 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3850
3851 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3852 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3853
3854 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3855 stats socket.
3856
3857
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003858option allbackups
3859no option allbackups
3860 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | no | yes | yes
3863 Arguments : none
3864
3865 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3866 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3867 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3868 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3869 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3870 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3871 order between the backup servers anymore.
3872
3873 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3874 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3875
3876 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3877 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3878
3879
3880option checkcache
3881no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003882 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3884 yes | no | yes | yes
3885 Arguments : none
3886
3887 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3888 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003889 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003890 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3891 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003892 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003893
3894 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003895 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003896 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003897 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3898 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003899 to the client are :
3900 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003901 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003902 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003903 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3904 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3905 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3906 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3907 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3908 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3909 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3910 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3911 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3912 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3913 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3914
3915 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003916 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003917 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003918 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003919 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3920
3921 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3922 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003923 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003924 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3925
3926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3928
3929
3930option clitcpka
3931no option clitcpka
3932 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | no
3935 Arguments : none
3936
3937 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3938 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3939 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3940 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3941
3942 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3943 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3944 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3945 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3946
3947 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3948 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3949 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3950 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3951 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3952
3953 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3954
3955 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3956 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3957 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3958
3959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3961
3962 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3963
3964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965option contstats
3966 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | yes | yes | no
3969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3972 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3973 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3974 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3975 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3976 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3977 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3978
3979
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003980option dontlog-normal
3981no option dontlog-normal
3982 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3984 yes | yes | yes | no
3985 Arguments : none
3986
3987 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3988 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3989 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3990 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3991 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3992 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3993 logged.
3994
3995 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3996 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3997 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003999 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004000 logging.
4001
4002
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004003option dontlognull
4004no option dontlognull
4005 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 yes | yes | yes | no
4008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4011 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4012 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4013 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4014 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4015 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4016 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4017
4018 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4019 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4020 would not be logged.
4021
4022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004025 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004026
4027
4028option forceclose
4029no option forceclose
4030 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004032 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004033 Arguments : none
4034
4035 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4036 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4037 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4038 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4039 global session times in the logs.
4040
4041 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004042 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004043 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004044
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004045 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4046 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4047 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4048
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004049 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4050 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004051
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4054
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004055 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004056
4057
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004058option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004059 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 yes | yes | yes | yes
4062 Arguments :
4063 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4064 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004065 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004066 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004067
4068 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4069 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4070 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4071 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4072 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4073 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4074 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004075 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4076 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4077 possible that the client has already brought one.
4078
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004079 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004080 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004081 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4082 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004083 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4084 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004085
4086 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4087 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4088 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4089 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4090 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4091 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4092 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4093
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004094 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4095 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4096 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4097 are under the control of the end-user.
4098
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004099 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004100 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4101 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004102 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4103 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4104 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004105
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004106 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004107 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4108 frontend www
4109 mode http
4110 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4111
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004112 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4113 backend www
4114 mode http
4115 option forwardfor header X-Client
4116
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004117 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004118 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004119
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004120
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004121option http-keep-alive
4122no option http-keep-alive
4123 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4125 yes | yes | yes | yes
4126 Arguments : none
4127
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004128 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4129 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4130 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4131 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4132 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4133 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4134 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4135
4136 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4137 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004138 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4139 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4140 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4141 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4142 situations where this option may be useful :
4143
4144 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4145 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4146
4147 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4148 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4149
4150 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4151 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4152 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4153 request.
4154
4155 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4156 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004157 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4158 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4159 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004160
4161 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4162 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4163
4164 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4165 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4166 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4167 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4168 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4169 not set.
4170
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004171 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4172 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004173 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004174 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004175
4176 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004177 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4178 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004179
4180
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004181option http-no-delay
4182no option http-no-delay
4183 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 yes | yes | yes | yes
4186 Arguments : none
4187
4188 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4189 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4190 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4191 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4192 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4193 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4194 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4195 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4196 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4197 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4198 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4199 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4200 affected.
4201
4202 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4203 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4204 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4205 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4206 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4207 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4208 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4209 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4210 latency environments.
4211
4212
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004213option http-pretend-keepalive
4214no option http-pretend-keepalive
4215 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | yes | yes | yes
4218 Arguments : none
4219
4220 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4221 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4222 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4223 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4224 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4225 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4226 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4227 consider the response complete.
4228
4229 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4230 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4231 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4232 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4233 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4234 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4235
4236 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4237 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4238 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4239 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4240 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4241 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4242 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4243
4244 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4245 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004246 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004247 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4248 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004249
4250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4252
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004253 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4254 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004255
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004256
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004257option http-server-close
4258no option http-server-close
4259 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4261 yes | yes | yes | yes
4262 Arguments : none
4263
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004264 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4265 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4266 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4267 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4268 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4269 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4270 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4271 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4272 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4273 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4274 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4275 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4276 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4277 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4278 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4279 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004280
4281 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4282 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4283 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4284 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004285 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4286 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004287
4288 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4289 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004290 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4291 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004292 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4293 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004294
4295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4297
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004298 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004299 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4300 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004301
4302
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004303option http-tunnel
4304no option http-tunnel
4305 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4307 yes | yes | yes | yes
4308 Arguments : none
4309
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004310 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4311 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4312 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4313 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4314 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4315 "option http-tunnel".
4316
4317 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004318 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004319 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4320 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4321 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4322 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4323 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4324 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4325 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004326
4327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4329
4330 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4331 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4332 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4333
4334
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004335option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004336no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004337 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | no
4340 Arguments : none
4341
4342 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4343 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4344 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4345 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4346 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4347 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4348 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4349
4350 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4351 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4352 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4353 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4354 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4355 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4356 request along its whole life.
4357
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004358 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4359 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4360 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4361 front of an existing proxy.
4362
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004363 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4364
4365 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4366 http-server-close".
4367
4368
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004369option httpchk
4370option httpchk <uri>
4371option httpchk <method> <uri>
4372option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4373 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 yes | no | yes | yes
4376 Arguments :
4377 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4378 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4379 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4380 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4381 ones.
4382
4383 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4384 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4385 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4386
4387 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4388 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4389 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4390 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4391 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4392
4393 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4394 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4395 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4396 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4397 the lack of any response.
4398
4399 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4400
4401 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4402 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4403 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4404
4405 Examples :
4406 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4407 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4408 backend https_relay
4409 mode tcp
4410 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4411 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4412
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004413 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4414 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4415 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004416
4417
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004418option httpclose
4419no option httpclose
4420 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | yes | yes | yes
4423 Arguments : none
4424
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004425 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4426 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4427 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4428 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004429 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004430 "option http-tunnel".
4431
4432 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4433 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4434 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4435 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4436 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4437 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4438 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4439 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004440
4441 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004442 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004443 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4444 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4445 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4446 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4447 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004448
4449 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4450 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004451 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4452 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004453 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4454 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004455
4456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4458
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004459 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4460 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004461
4462
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004463option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004464 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4466 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004467 Arguments :
4468 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4469 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4470 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4471 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4472 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004473
4474 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4475 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4476 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4477 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4478 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4479 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4480 ports.
4481
4482 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4483
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004484 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4485 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004487 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004488
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004489
4490option http_proxy
4491no option http_proxy
4492 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4494 yes | yes | yes | yes
4495 Arguments : none
4496
4497 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4498 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4499 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4500 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4501 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4502
4503 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4504 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4505 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4506 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004507 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004508 be analyzed.
4509
4510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4512
4513 Example :
4514 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4515 backend direct_forward
4516 option httpclose
4517 option http_proxy
4518
4519 See also : "option httpclose"
4520
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004521
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004522option independent-streams
4523no option independent-streams
4524 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4526 yes | yes | yes | yes
4527 Arguments : none
4528
4529 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4530 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4531 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4532 receive data or not.
4533
4534 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4535 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4536 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4537 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4538 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4539 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4540 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4541 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4542 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4543 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4544 socket buffers.
4545
4546 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4547 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4548 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4549 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4550 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4551
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004552 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004553 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4554 deprecated.
4555
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004556 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004557
4558
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004559option ldap-check
4560 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | no | yes | yes
4563 Arguments : none
4564
4565 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4566 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4567 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4568 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4569
4570 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4571 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4572
4573 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4574 configure it.
4575
4576 Example :
4577 option ldap-check
4578
4579 See also : "option httpchk"
4580
4581
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004582option external-check
4583 Use external processes for server health checks
4584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4585 yes | no | yes | yes
4586
4587 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4588 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4589 command".
4590
4591 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4592
4593 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4594
4595
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004596option log-health-checks
4597no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004598 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4600 yes | no | yes | yes
4601 Arguments : none
4602
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004603 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4604 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4605 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004606
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004607 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4608 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4609 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4610 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4611 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4612
4613 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4614 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004615
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004616 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4617 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4618 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004619
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004620
4621option log-separate-errors
4622no option log-separate-errors
4623 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4625 yes | yes | yes | no
4626 Arguments : none
4627
4628 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4629 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4630 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4631 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4632 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4633 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4634 provides very important information.
4635
4636 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4637 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4638 error logs.
4639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004640 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004641 logging.
4642
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004643
4644option logasap
4645no option logasap
4646 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 yes | yes | yes | no
4649 Arguments : none
4650
4651 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4652 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4653 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4654 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4655 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4656 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4657 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004658 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004659 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4660 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4661
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004662 Examples :
4663 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4664 mode http
4665 option httplog
4666 option logasap
4667 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4668
4669 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4670 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4671 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4672 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004674 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004675 logging.
4676
4677
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004678option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004679 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004682 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004683 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4684 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004685 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004686
4687 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4688 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4689 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4690 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4691 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4692 in the MySQL table, like this :
4693
4694 USE mysql;
4695 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4696 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4697
4698 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4699 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4700 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4701 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4702 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4703 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4704 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4705 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4706 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4707
4708 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4709 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004710
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004711 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004712
4713 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4714 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4715 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4716 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4717 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4718 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4719
4720 See also: "option httpchk"
4721
4722
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004723option nolinger
4724no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004725 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4727 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004728 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004729
4730 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4731 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4732 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4733 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4734 connections.
4735
4736 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4737 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4738 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4739 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4740 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4741 this too.
4742
4743 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4744 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4745 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4746
4747 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4748 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4749 for servers.
4750
4751 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4752 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4753
4754
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004755option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4756 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | yes | yes | yes
4759 Arguments :
4760 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4761 matching <network>
4762 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4763 header name.
4764
4765 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4766 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4767 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4768 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4769 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4770 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4771 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4772 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4773 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4774 possible that the client has already brought one.
4775
4776 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4777 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4778 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4779 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4780 header and requires different one.
4781
4782 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4783 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4784 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4785 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4786 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4787 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4788 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4789
4790 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4791 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4792 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4793 both are defined.
4794
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004795 Examples :
4796 # Original Destination address
4797 frontend www
4798 mode http
4799 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4800
4801 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4802 backend www
4803 mode http
4804 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4805
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004806 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4807 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004808
4809
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004810option persist
4811no option persist
4812 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004815 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004816
4817 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4818 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4819 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4820 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4821 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4822 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4823 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4824 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4825 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4826 redirected to another valid server.
4827
4828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4830
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004831 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004832
4833
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004834option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4835 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | no | yes | yes
4838 Arguments :
4839 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4840 PostgreSQL server.
4841
4842 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4843 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4844 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4845 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4846
4847 See also: "option httpchk"
4848
4849
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004850option prefer-last-server
4851no option prefer-last-server
4852 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 yes | no | yes | yes
4855 Arguments : none
4856
4857 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4858 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4859 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4860 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4861 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4862 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4863 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4864 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4865 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004866 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4867 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4868 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4869 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4870 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4871 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4872 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004873
4874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4876
4877 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4878
4879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004880option redispatch
4881no option redispatch
4882 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004885 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004886
4887 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4888 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4889 be able to access the service anymore.
4890
4891 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4892 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4893
4894 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4895 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4896 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004898 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4899 "redisp" keywords.
4900
4901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4903
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004904 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004905
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004906
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004907option redis-check
4908 Use redis health checks for server testing
4909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | no | yes | yes
4911 Arguments : none
4912
4913 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4914 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4915 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4916 find the "+PONG" response message.
4917
4918 Example :
4919 option redis-check
4920
4921 See also : "option httpchk"
4922
4923
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004924option smtpchk
4925option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4926 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4928 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004929 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004930 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4931 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4932 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4933
4934 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4935 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4936 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4937
4938 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4939 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4940 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4941 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4942 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4943 dead server.
4944
4945 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4946 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4947 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4948 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4949
4950 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4951 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4952 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4953 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4954 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4955
4956 Example :
4957 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4958
4959 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004962option socket-stats
4963no option socket-stats
4964
4965 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4967 yes | yes | yes | no
4968
4969 Arguments : none
4970
4971
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004972option splice-auto
4973no option splice-auto
4974 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4976 yes | yes | yes | yes
4977 Arguments : none
4978
4979 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4980 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4981 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4982 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004983 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004984 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4985 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4986 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4987 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4988
4989 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4990 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4991 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4992 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4993 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4994 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4995 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4996 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4997 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4998 keyword.
4999
5000 Example :
5001 option splice-auto
5002
5003 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5004 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5005
5006 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5007 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5008
5009
5010option splice-request
5011no option splice-request
5012 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | yes | yes | yes
5015 Arguments : none
5016
5017 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005018 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005019 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5020 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5021 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5022 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5023
5024 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5025
5026 Example :
5027 option splice-request
5028
5029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5031
5032 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5033 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5034
5035
5036option splice-response
5037no option splice-response
5038 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5040 yes | yes | yes | yes
5041 Arguments : none
5042
5043 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005044 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005045 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5046 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5047 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5048 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5049
5050 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5051
5052 Example :
5053 option splice-response
5054
5055 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5056 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5057
5058 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5059 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5060
5061
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005062option srvtcpka
5063no option srvtcpka
5064 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | no | yes | yes
5067 Arguments : none
5068
5069 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5070 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5071 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5072 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5073
5074 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5075 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5076 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5077 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5078
5079 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5080 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5081 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5082 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5083 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5084
5085 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5086
5087 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5088 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5089 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5090
5091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5093
5094 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5095
5096
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005097option ssl-hello-chk
5098 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5100 yes | no | yes | yes
5101 Arguments : none
5102
5103 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5104 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5105 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5106 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5107 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5108 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5109 hello message.
5110
5111 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5112 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5113 messages, which is appreciable.
5114
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005115 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5116 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5117 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005118
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005119 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5120
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005121
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005122option tcp-check
5123 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5125 yes | no | yes | yes
5126
5127 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5128 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5129
5130 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5131 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5132 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5133
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005134 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005135 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5136 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5137 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5138 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5139 only.
5140
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005141 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005142 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5143 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5144 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5145 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5146
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005147 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005148 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5149 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005150 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005151 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5152 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5153 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5154 the respective protocols.
5155 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5156 analysed.
5157
5158 Examples :
5159 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5160 option tcp-check
5161 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5162
5163 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5164 option tcp-check
5165 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5166
5167 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5168 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005169 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005170 option tcp-check
5171 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5172 tcp-check expect +PONG
5173 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5174 tcp-check expect string role:master
5175 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5176 tcp-check expect string +OK
5177
5178 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5179 (send many headers before analyzing)
5180 option tcp-check
5181 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5182 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5183 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5184 tcp-check send \r\n
5185 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5186
5187
5188 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5189
5190
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005191option tcp-smart-accept
5192no option tcp-smart-accept
5193 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | yes | yes | no
5196 Arguments : none
5197
5198 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5199 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5200 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5201 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5202 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5203 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5204
5205 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5206 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5207 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5208 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5209
5210 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5211 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5212 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5213 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5214
5215 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5216 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5217 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5218
5219 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5220 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5221 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5222
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005223 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5224
5225
5226option tcp-smart-connect
5227no option tcp-smart-connect
5228 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5230 yes | no | yes | yes
5231 Arguments : none
5232
5233 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5234 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5235 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5236 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5237 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5238
5239 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5240 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5241 complex.
5242
5243 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5244 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5245 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5246
5247 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5248 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5249
5250 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5251
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005252
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005253option tcpka
5254 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | yes | yes | yes
5257 Arguments : none
5258
5259 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5260 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5261 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5262 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5263
5264 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5265 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5266 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5267 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5268
5269 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5270 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5271 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5272 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5273 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5274
5275 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5276
5277 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5278 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5279 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5280 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5281 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5282 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5283 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5284 backends.
5285
5286 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5287
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005288
5289option tcplog
5290 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5292 yes | yes | yes | yes
5293 Arguments : none
5294
5295 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5296 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5297 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5298 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5299 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5300 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5301 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5302 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5303
5304 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005306 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005307
5308
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005309option transparent
5310no option transparent
5311 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005313 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005314 Arguments : none
5315
5316 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5317 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5318 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5319 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5320 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5321 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5322 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5323 appropriate server.
5324
5325 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5326 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5327
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005328 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005329 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005330
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005331
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005332external-check command <command>
5333 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | no | yes | yes
5336
5337 Arguments :
5338 <command> is the external command to run
5339
5340 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5341 command may be set using "external-check path".
5342
5343 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5344
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005345 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005346
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005347 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5348 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5349 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5350 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5351 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5352 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005353
5354 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5355 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5356 failed.
5357
5358 Example :
5359 external-check command /bin/true
5360
5361 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5362
5363
5364external-check path <path>
5365 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5367 yes | no | yes | yes
5368
5369 Arguments :
5370 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5371
5372 The default path is "".
5373
5374 Example :
5375 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5376
5377 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5378 "external-check command"
5379
5380
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005381persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005382persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005383 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | no | yes | yes
5386 Arguments :
5387 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005388 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5389 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005390
5391 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5392 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5393 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5394 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5395 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5396 forwarded to this server.
5397
5398 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5399 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5400 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005401 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005402 a single "listen" section.
5403
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005404 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5405 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5406 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5407
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005408 Example :
5409 listen tse-farm
5410 bind :3389
5411 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5412 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5413 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5414 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5415 persist rdp-cookie
5416 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005417 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005418 balance rdp-cookie
5419 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5420 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5421
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005422 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5423 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005424
5425
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005426rate-limit sessions <rate>
5427 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | yes | yes | no
5430 Arguments :
5431 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5432 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5433
5434 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5435 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5436 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5437 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5438 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5439 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5440
5441 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5442 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5443 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5444 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5445
5446 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5447 listen smtp
5448 mode tcp
5449 bind :25
5450 rate-limit sessions 10
5451 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5452
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005453 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5454 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5455 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005456
5457 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5458
5459
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005460redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5461redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5462redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005463 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 no | yes | yes | yes
5466
5467 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005468 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005469
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005471 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005472 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5473 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5474 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005475
5476 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5477 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5478 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5479 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5480 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005481 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5482 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5483 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5484 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005485
5486 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5487 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5488 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5489 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5490 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5491 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005492 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005493 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005494 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5495 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5496 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005497
5498 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005499 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5500 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5501 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5502 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5503 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5504 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5505 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5506 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005507
5508 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5509 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5510
5511 - "drop-query"
5512 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5513 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5514 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5515 with a location-type redirect.
5516
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005517 - "append-slash"
5518 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5519 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5520 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5521 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5522
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005523 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5524 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5525 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5526 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5527 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5528 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5529 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5530
5531 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5532 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5533 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5534 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5535 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5536 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5537 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005538
5539 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5540 acl clear dst_port 80
5541 acl secure dst_port 8080
5542 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005543 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005544 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005545 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5546
5547 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005548 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5549 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5550 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005551 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005552
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005553 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5554 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5555 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5556
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005557 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005558 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005559
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005560 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5561 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5562 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005564 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005565
5566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005567redisp (deprecated)
5568redispatch (deprecated)
5569 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005572 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005573
5574 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5575 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5576 be able to access the service anymore.
5577
5578 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5579 redistribute them to a working server.
5580
5581 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5582 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5583 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005585 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5586 "option redispatch" instead.
5587
5588 See also : "option redispatch"
5589
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005590
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005591reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005592 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 no | yes | yes | yes
5595 Arguments :
5596 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5597 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005598 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005599
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005600 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5601 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5602
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005603 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5604 the last header of an HTTP request.
5605
5606 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5607 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5608 responses.
5609
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005610 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5611 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5612 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5613
5614 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5615 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005616
5617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005618reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5619reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005620 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 no | yes | yes | yes
5623 Arguments :
5624 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5625 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5626 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5627 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5628 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5629 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5630 ignores case.
5631
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005632 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5633 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5634
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005635 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5636 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5637 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5638 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005639 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005640
5641 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5642 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5643
5644 Example :
5645 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5646 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5647 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005649 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5650 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005651
5652
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005653reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5654reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005655 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5657 no | yes | yes | yes
5658 Arguments :
5659 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5660 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5661 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5662 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5663 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5664 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5665
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005666 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5667 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5668
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005669 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5670 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5671 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5672 next servers.
5673
5674 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5675 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5676 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5677
5678 Example :
5679 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5680 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5681 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005683 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5684 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005685
5686
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005687reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5688reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005689 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 no | yes | yes | yes
5692 Arguments :
5693 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5694 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5695 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5696 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5697 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5698 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5699 case.
5700
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005701 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5702 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5703
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005704 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5705 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5706 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5707 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005708 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005710 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005711 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005712 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005713
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005714 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5715 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5716
5717 Example :
5718 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5719 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5720 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005722 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5723 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005724
5725
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005726reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5727reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005728 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 no | yes | yes | yes
5731 Arguments :
5732 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5733 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5734 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5735 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5736 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5737 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5738 case.
5739
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005740 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5741 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5742
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005743 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5744 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5745 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5746 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5747
5748 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5749 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5750
5751 Example :
5752 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5753 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5754 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5755 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5756
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005757 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5758 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005759
5760
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005761reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5762reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005763 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5765 no | yes | yes | yes
5766 Arguments :
5767 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5768 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5769 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5770 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5771 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5772 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5773
5774 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5775 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5776 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5777 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005778 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005779
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005780 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5781 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5782
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005783 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5784 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5785 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5786
5787 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5788 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5789 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5790 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5791 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5792
5793 Example :
5794 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005795 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005796 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5797 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5798
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005799 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5800 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005801
5802
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005803reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5804reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005805 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5807 no | yes | yes | yes
5808 Arguments :
5809 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5810 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5811 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5812 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5813 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5814 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5815 ignores case.
5816
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005817 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5818 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5819
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005820 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5821 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005822 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5823 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5824 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005825 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5826 not set.
5827
5828 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5829 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5830 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5831 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5832 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005834 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005835 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5836 # block all others.
5837 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5838 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5839
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005840 # block bad guys
5841 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5842 reqitarpit . if badguys
5843
5844 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5845 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005846
5847
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005848retries <value>
5849 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | no | yes | yes
5852 Arguments :
5853 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5854 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5855 default value is 3.
5856
5857 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5858 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5859 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5860
5861 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5862 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5863
5864 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5865 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5866
5867 See also : "option redispatch"
5868
5869
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005870rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005871 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5873 no | yes | yes | yes
5874 Arguments :
5875 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5876 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005877 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005878
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005879 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5880 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5881
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005882 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5883 the last header of an HTTP response.
5884
5885 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5886 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5887 responses.
5888
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005889 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5890 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005891
5892
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005893rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5894rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005895 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5897 no | yes | yes | yes
5898 Arguments :
5899 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5900 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5901 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5902 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5903 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5904 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5905 ignores case.
5906
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005907 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5908 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5909
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005910 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5911 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005912 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005913 client.
5914
5915 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5916 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5917 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5918
5919 Example :
5920 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005921 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005922
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005923 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5924 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005925
5926
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005927rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5928rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005929 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5931 no | yes | yes | yes
5932 Arguments :
5933 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5934 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5935 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5936 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5937 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5938 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5939 ignores case.
5940
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005941 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5942 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5943
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005944 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5945 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5946 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5947 case-sensitive.
5948
5949 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005950 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5951 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5952 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005953
5954 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5955 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5956
5957 Example :
5958 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5959 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5960
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005961 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5962 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005963
5964
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005965rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5966rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005967 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5969 no | yes | yes | yes
5970 Arguments :
5971 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5972 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5973 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5974 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5975 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5976 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5977 ignores case.
5978
5979 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5980 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5981 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5982 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005983 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005984
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005985 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5986 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5987
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005988 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5989 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5990 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5991
5992 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5993 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5994 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5995 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5996 are not case-sensitive.
5997
5998 Example :
5999 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6000 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6001
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006002 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6003 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006004
6005
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006006server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006007 Declare a server in a backend
6008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6009 no | no | yes | yes
6010 Arguments :
6011 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006012 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006013 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006014
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006015 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6016 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6017 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6018 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006019 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6020 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6021 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6022 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6023 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006024 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6025 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6026 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6027 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6028 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6029 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6030 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006031 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006032 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6033 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6034 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6035 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006037 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006038 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6039 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6040 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6041 adding this value to the client's port.
6042
6043 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6044 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006045 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006046
6047 Examples :
6048 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6049 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006050 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006051 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6052 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6053 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006054
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006055 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6056 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006057
6058
6059source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006060source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006061source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006062 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6064 yes | no | yes | yes
6065 Arguments :
6066 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6067 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006068
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006069 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006070 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6071 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6072 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6073 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6074 supported prefixes are :
6075 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6076 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6077 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006078 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006079 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6080 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6081 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6082 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006083
6084 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6085 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006086 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6087 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6088 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006089
6090 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6091 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6092 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6093 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6094 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6095 <addr>.
6096
6097 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6098 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6099 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6100 port.
6101
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006102 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6103 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6104 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6105 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006106 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006107 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6108 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6109 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6110 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6111 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6112 HTTP header.
6113
6114 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6115 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006116 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006117 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6118 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6119 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6120 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6121 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6122 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6123 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6124
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006125 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6126 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6127 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6128 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6129 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6130 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6131
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006132 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6133 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6134 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6135 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6136
6137 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6138 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6139 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6140 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6141 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6142 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6143
6144 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6145 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6146 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6147 there are two methods :
6148
6149 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6150 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6151 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6152 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6153 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6154 of the client ranges may be used.
6155
6156 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6157 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6158 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6159 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6160 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6161 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6162 same session.
6163
6164 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6165 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6166 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6167 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6168 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6169 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6170
6171 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6172 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6173 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006174 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006175
6176 Examples :
6177 backend private
6178 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6179 source 192.168.1.200
6180
6181 backend transparent_ssl1
6182 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6183 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6184
6185 backend transparent_ssl2
6186 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6187 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6188 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6189
6190 backend transparent_ssl3
6191 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6192 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6193 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6194
6195 backend transparent_smtp
6196 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6197 # with Tproxy version 4.
6198 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6199
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006200 backend transparent_http
6201 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6202 # proxy.
6203 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006205 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006206 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006208
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006209srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6210 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6212 yes | no | yes | yes
6213 Arguments :
6214 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6215 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6216 as explained at the top of this document.
6217
6218 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6219 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6220 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6221 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6222 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6223 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6224 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6225
6226 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6227 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6228 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6229 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6230 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006231 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006232 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006233 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006234
6235 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6236 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6237 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6238 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6239 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6240 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6241
6242 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6243 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6244
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006245 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6246 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006247
6248
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006249stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6250 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006252 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006253
6254 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6255 matched.
6256
6257 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6258 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6259
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006260 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6261 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6262 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6263
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006264 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6265 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6266 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6267 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006268
6269 Example :
6270 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6271 backend stats_localhost
6272 stats enable
6273 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6274
6275 Example :
6276 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6277 backend stats_auth
6278 stats enable
6279 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6280 stats admin if TRUE
6281
6282 Example :
6283 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6284 userlist stats-auth
6285 group admin users admin
6286 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6287 group readonly users haproxy
6288 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6289
6290 backend stats_auth
6291 stats enable
6292 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6293 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6294 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6295 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6296
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006297 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6298 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6299 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006300
6301
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006302stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6303 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006305 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006306 Arguments :
6307 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6308
6309 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6310
6311 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6312 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6313 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6314 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6315 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6316 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6317
6318 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6319 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6320 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006321 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006322
6323 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6324 report using "stats scope".
6325
6326 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6327 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6328 unobvious parameters.
6329
6330 Example :
6331 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6332 backend public_www
6333 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6334 stats enable
6335 stats hide-version
6336 stats scope .
6337 stats uri /admin?stats
6338 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6339 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6340 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6341
6342 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6343 backend private_monitoring
6344 stats enable
6345 stats uri /admin?stats
6346 stats refresh 5s
6347
6348 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6349
6350
6351stats enable
6352 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006354 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006355 Arguments : none
6356
6357 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6358 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6359 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6360 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6361 - stats auth : no authentication
6362 - stats scope : no restriction
6363
6364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6366 unobvious parameters.
6367
6368 Example :
6369 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6370 backend public_www
6371 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6372 stats enable
6373 stats hide-version
6374 stats scope .
6375 stats uri /admin?stats
6376 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6377 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6378 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6379
6380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6381 backend private_monitoring
6382 stats enable
6383 stats uri /admin?stats
6384 stats refresh 5s
6385
6386 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6387
6388
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006389stats hide-version
6390 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006392 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006393 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006394
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006395 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6396 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6397 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6398 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6399 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6400 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006402 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6403 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6404 unobvious parameters.
6405
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006406 Example :
6407 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6408 backend public_www
6409 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006410 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006411 stats hide-version
6412 stats scope .
6413 stats uri /admin?stats
6414 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6415 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6416 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006417
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006418 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6419 backend private_monitoring
6420 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006421 stats uri /admin?stats
6422 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006423
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006424 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006425
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006426
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006427stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6428 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6429 Access control for statistics
6430
6431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6432 no | no | yes | yes
6433
6434 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6435 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6436 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6437 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6438 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6439 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6440
6441 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6442 instance.
6443
6444 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6445 about ACL usage.
6446
6447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006448stats realm <realm>
6449 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006451 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006452 Arguments :
6453 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6454 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6455 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6456
6457 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6458 using a backslash ('\').
6459
6460 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6461 only related to authentication.
6462
6463 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6464 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6465 unobvious parameters.
6466
6467 Example :
6468 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6469 backend public_www
6470 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6471 stats enable
6472 stats hide-version
6473 stats scope .
6474 stats uri /admin?stats
6475 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6476 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6477 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6478
6479 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6480 backend private_monitoring
6481 stats enable
6482 stats uri /admin?stats
6483 stats refresh 5s
6484
6485 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6486
6487
6488stats refresh <delay>
6489 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006491 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006492 Arguments :
6493 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6494 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6495 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6496 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6497 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6498 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6499
6500 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6501 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6502 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6503 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6504
6505 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6506 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6507 unobvious parameters.
6508
6509 Example :
6510 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6511 backend public_www
6512 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6513 stats enable
6514 stats hide-version
6515 stats scope .
6516 stats uri /admin?stats
6517 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6518 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6519 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6520
6521 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6522 backend private_monitoring
6523 stats enable
6524 stats uri /admin?stats
6525 stats refresh 5s
6526
6527 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6528
6529
6530stats scope { <name> | "." }
6531 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006533 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006534 Arguments :
6535 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6536 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6537 section in which the statement appears.
6538
6539 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6540 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6541 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6542 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6543 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6544 exists.
6545
6546 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6547 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6548 unobvious parameters.
6549
6550 Example :
6551 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6552 backend public_www
6553 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6554 stats enable
6555 stats hide-version
6556 stats scope .
6557 stats uri /admin?stats
6558 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6559 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6560 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6561
6562 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6563 backend private_monitoring
6564 stats enable
6565 stats uri /admin?stats
6566 stats refresh 5s
6567
6568 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6569
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006570
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006571stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006572 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006574 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006575
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006576 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006577 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6578
6579 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6580 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6581
6582 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6583 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006584 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006585
6586 Example :
6587 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6588 backend private_monitoring
6589 stats enable
6590 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6591 stats uri /admin?stats
6592 stats refresh 5s
6593
6594 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6595 global section.
6596
6597
6598stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006599 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6601 yes | yes | yes | yes
6602 Arguments : none
6603
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006604 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006605 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6606 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6607 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6608 - IP (socket, server)
6609 - cookie (backend, server)
6610
6611 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6612 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006613 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006614
6615 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6616
6617
6618stats show-node [ <name> ]
6619 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006621 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006622 Arguments:
6623 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6624 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6625
6626 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6627 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006628 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006629
6630 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6631 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6632 unobvious parameters.
6633
6634 Example:
6635 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6636 backend private_monitoring
6637 stats enable
6638 stats show-node Europe-1
6639 stats uri /admin?stats
6640 stats refresh 5s
6641
6642 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6643 section.
6644
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006645
6646stats uri <prefix>
6647 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006649 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006650 Arguments :
6651 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6652 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6653 query string.
6654
6655 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6656 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6657 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6658 possible to reach it in the application.
6659
6660 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006661 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006662 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6663 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6664 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6665 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6666
6667 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6668 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6669 an address or a port to statistics only.
6670
6671 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6672 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6673 unobvious parameters.
6674
6675 Example :
6676 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6677 backend public_www
6678 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6679 stats enable
6680 stats hide-version
6681 stats scope .
6682 stats uri /admin?stats
6683 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6684 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6685 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6686
6687 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6688 backend private_monitoring
6689 stats enable
6690 stats uri /admin?stats
6691 stats refresh 5s
6692
6693 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6694
6695
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006696stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6697 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006699 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006700
6701 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006702 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006703 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6704 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6705 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6706
6707 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6708 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6709 the "stick-table" statement.
6710
6711 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6712 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6713 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6714 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6715 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6716
6717 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6718 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6719 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6720 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6721 transformation rules.
6722
6723 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6724 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6725 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6726 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6727 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6728 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6729 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6730
6731 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6732 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6733 ACL based conditions.
6734
6735 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6736 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6737 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6738 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6739
6740 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6741 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6742 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6743 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6744
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006745 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6746 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6747 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6748
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006749 Example :
6750 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6751 # last 30 minutes
6752 backend pop
6753 mode tcp
6754 balance roundrobin
6755 stick store-request src
6756 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6757 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6758 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6759
6760 backend smtp
6761 mode tcp
6762 balance roundrobin
6763 stick match src table pop
6764 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6765 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6766
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006767 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006768 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006769
6770
6771stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6772 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 no | no | yes | yes
6775
6776 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6777 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6778 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6779 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6780
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006781 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6782 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6783 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6784
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006785 Examples :
6786 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006787 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006788
6789 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6790 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6791 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6792
6793
6794 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6795 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6796 backend http
6797 mode http
6798 balance roundrobin
6799 stick on src table https
6800 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6801 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6802 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6803
6804 backend https
6805 mode tcp
6806 balance roundrobin
6807 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6808 stick on src
6809 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6810 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6811
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006812 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006813
6814
6815stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6816 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 no | no | yes | yes
6819
6820 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006821 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006822 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6823 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6824 server is selected.
6825
6826 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6827 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6828 the "stick-table" statement.
6829
6830 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6831 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6832 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6833 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6834 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6835 address.
6836
6837 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6838 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6839 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6840 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6841 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6842 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6843 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6844 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6845 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6846 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6847
6848 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6849 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6850 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6851 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6852 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6853 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6854 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6855
6856 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6857 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6858 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6859 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6860
6861 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6862 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6863 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6864 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6865 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6866 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006867 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6868 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6869 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6870 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6871 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6872 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006873
6874 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6875 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6876 the request.
6877
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006878 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6879 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6880 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6881
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006882 Example :
6883 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6884 # last 30 minutes
6885 backend pop
6886 mode tcp
6887 balance roundrobin
6888 stick store-request src
6889 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6890 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6891 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6892
6893 backend smtp
6894 mode tcp
6895 balance roundrobin
6896 stick match src table pop
6897 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6898 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6899
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006900 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006901 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006902
6903
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006904stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006905 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6906 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006907 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006909 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006910
6911 Arguments :
6912 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6913 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6914 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6915 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6916
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006917 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6918 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6919 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6920 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6921
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006922 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6923 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6924 instance.
6925
6926 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6927 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6928 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6929 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6930 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6931 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006932 to 32 characters.
6933
6934 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6935 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6936 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006937 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006938 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6939 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006940
6941 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006942 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6943 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006944 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6945 increase.
6946
6947 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006948 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6949 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6950 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006951
6952 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6953 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6954 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6955 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6956 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6957 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6958 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6959 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6960 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6961 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6962 parameter (see below).
6963
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006964 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6965 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6966 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6967 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6968 soft restart.
6969
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006970 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6971
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006972 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6973 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6974 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6975 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6976 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006977 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006978 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6979 if not expiration delay is specified.
6980
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006981 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6982 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6983 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6984 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006985 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6986 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6987 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6988 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6989 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6990 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6991 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6992 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6993 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6994 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6995 types and their arguments.
6996
6997 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6998 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6999 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7000 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7001
7002 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7003 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7004 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7005 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7006
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007007 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7008 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7009 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7010 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7011 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7012 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7013
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007014 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7015 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7016 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7017 they were received.
7018
7019 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7020 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7021 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7022 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7023 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7024
7025 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7026 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7027 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7028 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7029 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7030
7031 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7032 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7033 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7034
7035 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7036 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7037 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7038 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7039 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7040
7041 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7042 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7043 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7044 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7045 the client side.
7046
7047 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7048 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7049 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7050 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7051 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7052 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7053 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7054
7055 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7056 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7057 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7058 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7059 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7060 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7061 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7062
7063 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7064 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7065 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7066 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7067 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7068 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7069
7070 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7071 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7072 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7073 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7074
7075 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7076 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7077 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7078 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7079 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7080 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7081 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7082 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7083 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7084 recommended for better fairness.
7085
7086 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7087 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7088 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7089 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7090
7091 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7092 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7093 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7094 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7095 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7096 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7097 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7098 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7099 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7100 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007101
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007102 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7103 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007104 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7105 reference it.
7106
7107 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7108 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7109 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7110 as an exclusive stickiness.
7111
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007112 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7113 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7114 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7115 something that can be ignored.
7116
7117 Example:
7118 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7119 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7120 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7121 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7122
7123 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007124 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007125
7126
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007127stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7128 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7130 no | no | yes | yes
7131
7132 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007133 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007134 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7135 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7136 server is selected.
7137
7138 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7139 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7140 the "stick-table" statement.
7141
7142 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7143 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7144 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7145 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7146
7147 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7148 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7149 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7150 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7151 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7152 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007153 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007154 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7155 rules.
7156
7157 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7158 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7159 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7160 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7161 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7162 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7163 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7164
7165 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7166 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7167 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7168 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7169
7170 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7171 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7172 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7173 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7174 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7175 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007176 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7177 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7178 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7179 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7180 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7181 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7182 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7183 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7184 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007185
7186 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7187
7188 Example :
7189 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7190 backend https
7191 mode tcp
7192 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007193 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007194 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007195
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007196 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7197 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7198
7199 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7200 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7201 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7202
7203 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7204 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007205
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007206 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7207 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7208 # at offset 44.
7209
7210 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7211 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7212
7213 # Learn on response if server hello.
7214 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007215
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007216 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7217 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7218
7219 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7220 extraction.
7221
7222
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007223tcp-check connect [params*]
7224 Opens a new connection
7225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7226 no | no | yes | yes
7227
7228 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7229 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7230 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7231
7232 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7233 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7234 of the sequence.
7235
7236 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7237 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7238 do.
7239
7240 Parameters :
7241 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7242 use the TCP connection.
7243
7244 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7245 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7246 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7247
7248 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7249
7250 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7251
7252 Examples:
7253 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7254 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7255 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7256 option tcp-check
7257 tcp-check connect
7258 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7259 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7260 tcp-check send \r\n
7261 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7262 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7263 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7264 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7265 tcp-check send \r\n
7266 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7267 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7268
7269 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7270 option tcp-check
7271 tcp-check connect port 110
7272 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7273 tcp-check connect port 143
7274 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7275 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7276
7277 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7278
7279
7280tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7281 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 no | no | yes | yes
7284
7285 Arguments :
7286 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7287 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7288 binary.
7289 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7290 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7291 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7292
7293 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7294 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7295 with the usual backslash ('\').
7296 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7297 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7298 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7299 used upper or lower case.
7300
7301
7302 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7303
7304 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7305 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7306 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7307 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7308 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7309 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7310 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7311 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7312
7313 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7314 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7315 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7316 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7317 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7318 expression.
7319
7320 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7321 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7322 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7323 this exact hexadecimal string.
7324 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7325
7326 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7327 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7328 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7329 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7330 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7331 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7332 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7333 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7334 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7335 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7336 the null character.
7337
7338 Examples :
7339 # perform a POP check
7340 option tcp-check
7341 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7342
7343 # perform an IMAP check
7344 option tcp-check
7345 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7346
7347 # look for the redis master server
7348 option tcp-check
7349 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7350 tcp-check expect +PONG
7351 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7352 tcp-check expect string role:master
7353 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7354 tcp-check expect string +OK
7355
7356
7357 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7358 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7359
7360
7361tcp-check send <data>
7362 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7364 no | no | yes | yes
7365
7366 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7367 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7368
7369 Examples :
7370 # look for the redis master server
7371 option tcp-check
7372 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7373 tcp-check expect string role:master
7374
7375 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7376 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7377
7378
7379tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7380 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7381 tcp health check
7382 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7383 no | no | yes | yes
7384
7385 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7386 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7387 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7388 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7389 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7390 hexadecimal string.
7391 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7392
7393 Examples :
7394 # redis check in binary
7395 option tcp-check
7396 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7397 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7398
7399
7400 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7401 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7402
7403
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007404tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7405 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7407 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007408 Arguments :
7409 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007410 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7411 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007412
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007413 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007414
7415 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7416 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007417 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7418 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7419 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7420 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7421 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7422 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007423
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007424 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7425 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7426 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7427 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007428
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007429 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007430 - accept :
7431 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7432 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7433 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007434
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007435 - reject :
7436 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7437 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7438 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7439 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7440 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7441 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7442 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7443 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7444 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7445 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7446 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7447 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007448
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007449 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7450 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7451 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7452 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7453 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7454 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7455 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7456 hosts.
7457
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007458 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7459 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7460 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7461 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7462 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7463 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7464 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7465 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7466 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7467 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7468 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7469
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007470 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007471 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007472 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007473 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007474 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7475 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007476 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007477 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7478 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7479 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7480 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7481 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007483 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007484 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007485 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007486 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7487 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7488 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7489 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007491 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7492 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7493 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7494 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007496 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7497 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7498 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7499 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7500 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007501 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7502 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7503 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7504 layer7 information is extracted.
7505
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007506 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7507 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7508 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7509 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7510 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007512 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7513 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7514 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007515
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007516 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7517 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7518 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007520 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007521 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007522 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007524 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7525 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7526 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007528 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007529 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7530 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007531
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007532 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7533
7534 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7535
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007536 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7537
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007538 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007539
7540
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007541tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7542 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007544 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007545 Arguments :
7546 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007547 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007548 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7549 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007550
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007551 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7554 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7555 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7556 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7557 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007559 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7560 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7561 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7562 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007563 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7564 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7565 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7566 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7567 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7568 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007569 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007570 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007572 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7573 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7574 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7575 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007576
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007577 Four types of actions are supported :
7578 - accept : the request is accepted
7579 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7580 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007581 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007583 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7584 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007585
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007586 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7587 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7588 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7589 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7590 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7591 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007593 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007594 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7595 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007596
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007597 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007598 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7599 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7600 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7601 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007602 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7603 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7604 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007605
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007606 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007607 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7608 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7609 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007610
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007611 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007612 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7613 # and reject everything else.
7614 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7615 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007616 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007617 tcp-request content reject
7618
7619 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007620 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7621 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7622 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007623 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007624
7625 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7626 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7627 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007628 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007629 tcp-request content reject
7630
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007631 Example:
7632 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7633 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007634 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007635
7636 Example:
7637 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7638 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007639 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007640
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007641 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7642 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7643
7644 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007645 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007646 # protecting all our sites
7647 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007648 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7649 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007650 ...
7651 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7652
7653 backend http_dynamic
7654 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007655 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007656 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007657 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7658 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7659 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007660 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007662 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007663
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007664 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007665
7666
7667tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7668 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007670 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007671 Arguments :
7672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7674 as explained at the top of this document.
7675
7676 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7677 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7678 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7679 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7680 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7681
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007682 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7683 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7684 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7685 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7686
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007687 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7688 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007689 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007690 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007691 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7692 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7693 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7694 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007695
7696 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7697 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7698 it pass through unaffected.
7699
7700 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7701 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7702 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007703 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007704 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7705 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007706 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7707 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7708 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007709
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007710 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007711 "timeout client".
7712
7713
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007714tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7715 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7717 no | no | yes | yes
7718 Arguments :
7719 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007720 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007721
7722 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7723
7724 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7725 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7726 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007727 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7728 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007729
7730 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7731
7732 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7733 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7734 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7735 inserted.
7736
7737 Two types of actions are supported :
7738 - accept :
7739 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7740 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7741 the rules evaluation.
7742
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007743 - close :
7744 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7745 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7746 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7747 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7748 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7749 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007750 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007751 protocols.
7752
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007753 - reject :
7754 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7755 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007756 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007757
7758 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7759 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7760 for changing the default action to a reject.
7761
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007762 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7763 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7764 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7765 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007766 period.
7767
7768 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7769
7770 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7771
7772
7773tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7774 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7776 no | no | yes | yes
7777 Arguments :
7778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7780 as explained at the top of this document.
7781
7782 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7783
7784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007785timeout check <timeout>
7786 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7787 established.
7788
7789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7790 yes | no | yes | yes
7791 Arguments:
7792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7794 as explained at the top of this document.
7795
7796 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7797 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7798 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7799 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007800 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7801 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7802 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007803
7804 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7805 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7806
7807 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7808 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007809 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007810
7811 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7812 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7813 forget about it.
7814
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007815 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7816 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007817
7818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007819timeout client <timeout>
7820timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7821 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | yes | yes | no
7824 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007825 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7827 as explained at the top of this document.
7828
7829 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7830 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7831 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7832 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7833 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7834 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7835 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7836 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007837 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007838 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007839 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7840 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007841 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7842 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007843
7844 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7845 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7846 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7847 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7848 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7849 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7850
7851 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7852 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7853 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7854
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007855 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007856
7857
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007858timeout client-fin <timeout>
7859 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | yes | yes | no
7862 Arguments :
7863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7865 as explained at the top of this document.
7866
7867 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7868 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7869 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7870 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7871 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7872 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7873 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7874 down in one direction.
7875
7876 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7877 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7878 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7879
7880 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7881
7882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007883timeout connect <timeout>
7884timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7885 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7887 yes | no | yes | yes
7888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007889 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007890 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7891 as explained at the top of this document.
7892
7893 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007894 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007895 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007896 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007897 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7898 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007899
7900 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7901 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7902 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7903 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7904 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7905 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7906
7907 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7908 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7909 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7910
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007911 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7912 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007913
7914
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007915timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7916 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7918 yes | yes | yes | yes
7919 Arguments :
7920 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7921 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7922 as explained at the top of this document.
7923
7924 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7925 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7926 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7927 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7928 once the request has started to present itself.
7929
7930 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7931 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7932 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7933 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7934 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7935
7936 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7937 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7938 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7939 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7940
7941 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7942 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7943 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7944 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7945 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007946 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007947
7948 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7949 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7950 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7951 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7952
7953 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7954
7955
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007956timeout http-request <timeout>
7957 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007959 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007960 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007961 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007962 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7963 as explained at the top of this document.
7964
7965 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7966 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7967 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7968 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7969 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7970 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7971 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007972 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7973 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7974 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7975 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7976 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7977 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7978 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007979
7980 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7981 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007982 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7983 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007984
7985 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7986 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7987 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7988 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7989 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7990
7991 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007992 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7993 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7994 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007995
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007996 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007997
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007998
7999timeout queue <timeout>
8000 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8002 yes | no | yes | yes
8003 Arguments :
8004 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8005 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8006 as explained at the top of this document.
8007
8008 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8009 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8010 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8011 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8012 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8013
8014 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8015 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8016 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8017 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8018
8019 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8020
8021
8022timeout server <timeout>
8023timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8024 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 yes | no | yes | yes
8027 Arguments :
8028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8030 as explained at the top of this document.
8031
8032 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8033 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8034 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8035 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8036 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8037 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8038 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8039
8040 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8041 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8042 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8043 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8044 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008045 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008046 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008047 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8048 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8049 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8050 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008051
8052 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8053 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8054 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8055 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8056 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8057 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8058
8059 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8060 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8061 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8062
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008063 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008064
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008065
8066timeout server-fin <timeout>
8067 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8069 yes | no | yes | yes
8070 Arguments :
8071 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8072 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8073 as explained at the top of this document.
8074
8075 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8076 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8077 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8078 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8079 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8080 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8081 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8082 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8083 situations, it should not be needed.
8084
8085 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8086 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8087 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8088
8089 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8090
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008091
8092timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008093 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8095 yes | yes | yes | yes
8096 Arguments :
8097 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8098 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8099 as explained at the top of this document.
8100
8101 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8102 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8103 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8104
8105 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8106 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8107 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8108 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008109 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008110
8111 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8112
8113
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008114timeout tunnel <timeout>
8115 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8117 yes | no | yes | yes
8118 Arguments :
8119 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8120 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8121 as explained at the top of this document.
8122
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008123 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008124 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8125 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8126 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8127 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8128 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8129 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8130 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8131 specified.
8132
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008133 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8134 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8135 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8136 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8137 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8138 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8139 state.
8140
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008141 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8142 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8143 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8144 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8145 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8146
8147 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8148 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8149 forget about it.
8150
8151 Example :
8152 defaults http
8153 option http-server-close
8154 timeout connect 5s
8155 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008156 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008157 timeout server 30s
8158 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8159
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008160 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008161
8162
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008163transparent (deprecated)
8164 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008166 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008167 Arguments : none
8168
8169 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8170 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8171 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8172 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8173 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8174 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8175 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8176 appropriate server.
8177
8178 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8179
8180 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8181 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8182
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008183 See also: "option transparent"
8184
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008185unique-id-format <string>
8186 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8188 yes | yes | yes | no
8189 Arguments :
8190 <string> is a log-format string.
8191
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008192 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8193 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8194 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8195 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008196
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008197 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8198 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8199 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8200 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8201 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8202 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8203 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8204 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008205
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008206 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8207 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008209 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008210
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008211 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008212
8213 will generate:
8214
8215 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8216
8217 See also: "unique-id-header"
8218
8219unique-id-header <name>
8220 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8222 yes | yes | yes | no
8223 Arguments :
8224 <name> is the name of the header.
8225
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008226 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8227 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008228
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008229 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008230
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008231 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008232 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8233
8234 will generate:
8235
8236 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8237
8238 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008239
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008240use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008241 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8243 no | yes | yes | no
8244 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008245 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8246 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008247
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008248 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8249 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008250
8251 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8252 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8253 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008254 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8255 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8256 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8257 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008258
8259 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8260 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8261 assign the backend.
8262
8263 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8264 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8265 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8266 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8267 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8268 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8269
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008270 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008271 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008272 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8273 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8274 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8275
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008276 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8277 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8278 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8279 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8280 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8281 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8282 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8283 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8284 cannot be forced from the request.
8285
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008286 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008287 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8288 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8289
8290 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8291 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008292
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008293
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008294use-server <server> if <condition>
8295use-server <server> unless <condition>
8296 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8298 no | no | yes | yes
8299 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008300 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008301
8302 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8303
8304 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8305 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8306 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8307
8308 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8309 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8310 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8311 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8312 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8313 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8314 matches will assign the server.
8315
8316 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8317 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8318 with the next rules until one matches.
8319
8320 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8321 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8322 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8323 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8324
8325 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8326 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8327 stripped.
8328
8329 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8330 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8331 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8332 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8333
8334 Example :
8335 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8336 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8337 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8338 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8339 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8340 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8341 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8342 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8343 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8344
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008345 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008346
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008347
83485. Bind and Server options
8349--------------------------
8350
8351The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8352depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8353settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8354written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8355described in this section.
8356
8357
83585.1. Bind options
8359-----------------
8360
8361The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8362as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8363no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8364parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8365while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8366provided immediately after the setting name.
8367
8368The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8369
8370accept-proxy
8371 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008372 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8373 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008374 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8375 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8376 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8377 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8378 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8379 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8380 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008381 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8382 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008383
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008384alpn <protocols>
8385 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8386 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8387 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8388 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8389 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8390 initial NPN extension.
8391
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008392backlog <backlog>
8393 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8394 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8395
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008396ecdhe <named curve>
8397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008398 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8399 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008400
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008401ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008402 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8403 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8404 client's certificate.
8405
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008406ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8407 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8408 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8409 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8410 error is ignored.
8411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008412ciphers <ciphers>
8413 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8414 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008415 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008416 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8417 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8418
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008419crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008420 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8421 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8422 to verify client's certificate.
8423
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008424crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008425 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8426 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8427 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8428 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8429 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8430 file.
8431
8432 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8433 are loaded.
8434
8435 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008436 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8437 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008438 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8439 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8440 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8441 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8442 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8443 www.sub.example.org).
8444
8445 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8446 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8447 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8448 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8449 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8450
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008451 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008452
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008453 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8454 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008455 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008456 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8457 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8458 clients).
8459
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008460 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8461 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8462 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8463 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8464 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8465 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8466 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8467 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8468 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8469 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8470 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8471 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8472 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8473
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008474crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8476 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008477 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008478 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008479
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008480crt-list <file>
8481 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008482 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8483 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008484
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008485 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008486
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008487 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8488 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8489 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8490 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8491 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8492 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8493 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8494 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008496defer-accept
8497 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8498 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8499 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8500 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8501 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8502 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8503 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8504 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8505 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8506 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8507 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8508
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008509force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008510 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008511 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008512 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8513 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008514
8515force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008516 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008517 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8518 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008519
8520force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008521 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008522 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8523 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008524
8525force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008526 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008527 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8528 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008530gid <gid>
8531 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8532 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8533 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8534 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8535 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8536
8537group <group>
8538 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8539 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8540 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8541 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8542 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8543
8544id <id>
8545 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8546 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8547 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8548 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8549
8550interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008551 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8552 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8553 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8554 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8555 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8556 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8557 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008558
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008559level <level>
8560 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8561 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8562 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8563 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8564 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8565 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8566 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8567 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8568 counters).
8569 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8570 all counters).
8571
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008572maxconn <maxconn>
8573 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8574 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8575 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8576 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8577 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8578 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8579 eat all memory.
8580
8581mode <mode>
8582 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8583 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8584 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8585 UNIX sockets.
8586
8587mss <maxseg>
8588 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8589 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8590 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8591 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8592 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8593 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8594 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8595 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8596 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8597 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8598 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8599
8600name <name>
8601 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8602 page.
8603
8604nice <nice>
8605 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8606 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8607 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8608 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8609 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8610 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8611 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8612 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8613 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8614 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8615 one for an RDP socket.
8616
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008617no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008619 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008620 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008621 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8622 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008623 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008624
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008625no-tls-tickets
8626 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8627 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8628 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008629 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8630 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008631
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008632no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008634 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008635 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008636 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8637 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8638 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008639
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008640no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008641 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008642 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008643 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008644 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8645 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8646 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008647
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008648no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008650 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008651 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008652 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8653 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8654 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008655
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008656npn <protocols>
8657 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8658 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8659 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8660 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008661 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8662 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008663
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008664process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8665 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8666 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8667 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8668 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8669 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8670 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8671 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008672 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8673 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8674 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8675 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8676 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8677 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8678 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008679
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008680ssl
8681 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008682 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008683 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8684 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8685 to deciphered contents.
8686
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008687strict-sni
8688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8689 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8690 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8691 See the "crt" option for more information.
8692
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008693tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008694 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008695 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8696 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8697 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8698 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8699 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8700 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8701 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008702 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8703 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8704 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008705
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008706transparent
8707 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8708 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8709 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8710 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8711 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8712 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8713 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8714 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8715 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8716 so check for support with your vendor.
8717
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008718v4v6
8719 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8720 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8721 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8722 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008723 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008724
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008725v6only
8726 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8727 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8728 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008729 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8730 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008731
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008732uid <uid>
8733 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8734 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8735 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8736 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8737 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8738
8739user <user>
8740 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8741 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8742 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8743 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8744 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8745
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008746verify [none|optional|required]
8747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8748 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8749 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8750 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8751 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008752 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8753 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8754 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8755 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008756
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020087575.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008758------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008760The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8761which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8762arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8763settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8764after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8765Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8766address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008768 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008769 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008771The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008772
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008773addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008774 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8775 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8776 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8777 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8778 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008780 Supported in default-server: No
8781
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008782agent-check
8783 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008784 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8785 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8786 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8787 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008788
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008789 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008790 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008791 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8792 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8793 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008794
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008795 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8796 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008797
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008798 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8799 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8800 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008801
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008802 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8803 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8804 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008805
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008806 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8807 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8808 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8809 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8810 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8811 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8812 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008813
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008814 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8815 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008816
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008817 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8818 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8819 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8820 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8821 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8822 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8823 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8824 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8825 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008826
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008827 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8828 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008829 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8830 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8831 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8832 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008833
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008834 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8835 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008836
8837 Supported in default-server: No
8838
8839agent-inter <delay>
8840 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8841 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8842
8843 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8844 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8845 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8846 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8847 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8848 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8849 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8850 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8851 of backends use the same servers.
8852
8853 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8854
8855 Supported in default-server: Yes
8856
8857agent-port <port>
8858 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8859
8860 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8861
8862 Supported in default-server: Yes
8863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008864backup
8865 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8866 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8867 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8868 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8869 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8870 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008872 Supported in default-server: No
8873
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008874ca-file <cafile>
8875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8876 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8877 server's certificate.
8878
8879 Supported in default-server: No
8880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008881check
8882 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008883 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8884 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8885 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8886 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8887 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8888 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8889 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008890 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8891 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8892 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008894 Supported in default-server: No
8895
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008896check-send-proxy
8897 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8898 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8899 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8900 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8901 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8902 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8903 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8904
8905 Supported in default-server: No
8906
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008907check-ssl
8908 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8909 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8910 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8911 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008912 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008913 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8914 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8915 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8916 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8917
8918 Supported in default-server: No
8919
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008920ciphers <ciphers>
8921 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008922 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008923 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8924 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8925 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8926 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8927 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8928 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8929
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008930 Supported in default-server: No
8931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008932cookie <value>
8933 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8934 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8935 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8936 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8937 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8938 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8939 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008941 Supported in default-server: No
8942
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008943crl-file <crlfile>
8944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8945 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8946 to verify server's certificate.
8947
8948 Supported in default-server: No
8949
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008950crt <cert>
8951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8952 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8953 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8954 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8955 certificate request.
8956
8957 Supported in default-server: No
8958
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008959disabled
8960 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8961 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8962 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8963 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8964 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8965
8966 Supported in default-server: No
8967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008968error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008969 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8970 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8971 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008973 Supported in default-server: Yes
8974
8975 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008977fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008978 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8979 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8980 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008982 Supported in default-server: Yes
8983
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008984force-sslv3
8985 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8986 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008987 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8988 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008989
8990 Supported in default-server: No
8991
8992force-tlsv10
8993 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008994 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8995 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008996
8997 Supported in default-server: No
8998
8999force-tlsv11
9000 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009001 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9002 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009003
9004 Supported in default-server: No
9005
9006force-tlsv12
9007 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009008 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9009 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009010
9011 Supported in default-server: No
9012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009013id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009014 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9015 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9016 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009018 Supported in default-server: No
9019
9020inter <delay>
9021fastinter <delay>
9022downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009023 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9024 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9025 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9026 between checks depending on the server state :
9027
9028 Server state | Interval used
9029 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9030 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9031 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9032 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9033 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9034 or yet unchecked. |
9035 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9036 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9037 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009039 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9040 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9041 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9042 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009043 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9044 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9045 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9046 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9047 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009049 Supported in default-server: Yes
9050
9051maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009052 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9053 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9054 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9055 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9056 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9057 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9058 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9059 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009061 Supported in default-server: Yes
9062
9063maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009064 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9065 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9066 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9067 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9068 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9069 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9070 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009072 Supported in default-server: Yes
9073
9074minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009075 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9076 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9077 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9078 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9079 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9080 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009081 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009082 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009084 Supported in default-server: Yes
9085
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009086no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009087 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9088 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009089 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009090
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009091 Supported in default-server: No
9092
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009093no-tls-tickets
9094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9095 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9096 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009097 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9098 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009099
9100 Supported in default-server: No
9101
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009102no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009103 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009104 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9105 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009106 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9107 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9108 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009109
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009110 Supported in default-server: No
9111
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009112no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009113 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009114 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9115 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009116 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9117 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9118 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009119
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009120 Supported in default-server: No
9121
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009122no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009123 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009124 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9125 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009126 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9127 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9128 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009129
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009130 Supported in default-server: No
9131
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009132non-stick
9133 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9134 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9135 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9136
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009137 Supported in default-server: No
9138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009139observe <mode>
9140 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9141 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9142 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9143 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9144 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9145 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009146 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009148 Supported in default-server: No
9149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009150 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009152on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009153 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9154 Currently, four modes are available:
9155 - fastinter: force fastinter
9156 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9157 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9158 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9159 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009161 Supported in default-server: Yes
9162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009163 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9164
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009165on-marked-down <action>
9166 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9167 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009168 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9169 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9170 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9171 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9172 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9173 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9174 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9175 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009176
9177 Actions are disabled by default
9178
9179 Supported in default-server: Yes
9180
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009181on-marked-up <action>
9182 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9183 Currently one action is available:
9184 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9185 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9186 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9187 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9188 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9189 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9190 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9191 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9192
9193 Actions are disabled by default
9194
9195 Supported in default-server: Yes
9196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009197port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009198 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9199 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9200 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9201 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9202 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9203 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009205 Supported in default-server: Yes
9206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009207redir <prefix>
9208 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9209 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9210 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9211 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9212 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9213 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9214 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9215 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009216 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009217 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9218 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9219 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9220 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9221 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9222
9223 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009225 Supported in default-server: No
9226
9227rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009228 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9229 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9230 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009232 Supported in default-server: Yes
9233
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009234send-proxy
9235 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9236 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9237 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9238 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9239 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9240 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9241 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9242 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9243 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009244 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9245 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9246 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9247 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9248 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009249
9250 Supported in default-server: No
9251
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009252send-proxy-v2
9253 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9254 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9255 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9256 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9257 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9258 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9259 option of the "bind" keyword.
9260
9261 Supported in default-server: No
9262
9263send-proxy-v2-ssl
9264 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9265 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9266 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9267 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9268 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9269 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9270 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9271 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9272
9273 Supported in default-server: No
9274
9275send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9276 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9277 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9278 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9279 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9280 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9281 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9282 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9283 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9284 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9285
9286 Supported in default-server: No
9287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009288slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009289 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9290 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9291 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9292 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9293 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9294 parameters :
9295
9296 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9297 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9298
9299 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9300 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9301 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9302 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9303
9304 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9305 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9306 seen as failed.
9307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009308 Supported in default-server: Yes
9309
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009310source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009311source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009312source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009313 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9314 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9315 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9316 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9317
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009318 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9319 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9320 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9321 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9322 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9323 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9324 server.
9325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009326 Supported in default-server: No
9327
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009328ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009329 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9330 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9331 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9332 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9333 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9334 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009335 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009336
9337 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009339track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009340 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9341 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9342 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9343 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009344 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009346 Supported in default-server: No
9347
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009348verify [none|required]
9349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009350 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9351 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9352 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9353 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009354 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9355 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9356 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009357
9358 Supported in default-server: No
9359
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009360verifyhost <hostname>
9361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9362 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9363 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9364 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9365 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9366 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9367
9368 Supported in default-server: No
9369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009370weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009371 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9372 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9373 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009374 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9375 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9376 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9377 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9378 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9379 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009381 Supported in default-server: Yes
9382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009383
93846. HTTP header manipulation
9385---------------------------
9386
9387In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9388response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9389request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9390which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009391against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009392
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009393If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9394to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9395but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9396HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9397stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9398because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9399a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9400still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009402This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9403in section 4.2 :
9404
9405 - reqadd <string>
9406 - reqallow <search>
9407 - reqiallow <search>
9408 - reqdel <search>
9409 - reqidel <search>
9410 - reqdeny <search>
9411 - reqideny <search>
9412 - reqpass <search>
9413 - reqipass <search>
9414 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9415 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9416 - reqtarpit <search>
9417 - reqitarpit <search>
9418 - rspadd <string>
9419 - rspdel <search>
9420 - rspidel <search>
9421 - rspdeny <search>
9422 - rspideny <search>
9423 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9424 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9425
9426With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9427is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9428parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9429prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9430Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9431
9432 \t for a tab
9433 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9434 \n for a new line (LF)
9435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9436 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9437 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9438 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9439 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9440
9441The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9442portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9443above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9444regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
94459 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9446is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9447
9448The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9449after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9450
9451Notes related to these keywords :
9452---------------------------------
9453 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9454 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9455 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9456
9457 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9458 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9459 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9460
9461 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9462 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9463 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9464 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9465 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9466
9467 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9468 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9469 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9470 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9471 useless headers before adding new ones.
9472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009473 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009474 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9475
9476 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9477 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9478 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9479
9480 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9481 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009482 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009483
9484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094857. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9486----------------------------------
9487
9488Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9489client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9490The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9491these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9492but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9493data called patterns.
9494
9495
94967.1. ACL basics
9497---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009498
9499The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9500content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9501from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9502simple :
9503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009504 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009505 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009506 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9507 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009509The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9510adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009511
9512In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009514 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009515
9516This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9517Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9518and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009519an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9520conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9521as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9522are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009523
9524ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9525'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9526which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9527
9528There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9529performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9532specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9533this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009534methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9535ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009536
9537Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9538 - boolean
9539 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9540 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9541 - string
9542 - data block
9543
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009544Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9545converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9546would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9547The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9548which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9549
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009550Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9551keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9552fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9553which are summarized in the table below :
9554
9555 +---------------------+-----------------+
9556 | Sample or converter | Default |
9557 | output type | matching method |
9558 +---------------------+-----------------+
9559 | boolean | bool |
9560 +---------------------+-----------------+
9561 | integer | int |
9562 +---------------------+-----------------+
9563 | ip | ip |
9564 +---------------------+-----------------+
9565 | string | str |
9566 +---------------------+-----------------+
9567 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9568 +---------------------+-----------------+
9569
9570Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9571matching method, see below.
9572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009573The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9574 - boolean
9575 - integer or integer range
9576 - IP address / network
9577 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9578 - regular expression
9579 - hex block
9580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009581The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9582
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009583 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9584 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009585 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009586 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009587 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009588 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009589 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009591The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9592read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9593if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9594lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9595will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9596beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9597a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9598lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9599exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9600
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009601The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9602parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9603ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9604a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9605check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9606
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009607The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9608socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9609file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009611Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9612loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9613
9614 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9615
9616In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9617the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9618case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9619as well.
9620
9621The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9622sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9623do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9624methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9625is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9626obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9627followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9628default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9629that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9630string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9631
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009632The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9633By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9634string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9635resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9636server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9637waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9638flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9639function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009641There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9642sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9643be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009644
9645 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9646 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009647 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9648 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9649 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9650 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009651
9652 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9653 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009654 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009655
9656 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009658
9659 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009660 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009661
9662 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9663 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9664
9665 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9666 binary or string samples.
9667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9669 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009671 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9672 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9673 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009675 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9676 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009678 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9679 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009681 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9682 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009684 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9685 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009686 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009688 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9689 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9690 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009691
9692For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9693request, it is possible to do :
9694
9695 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9696
9697In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9698buffer, one would use the following acl :
9699
9700 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9701
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009702On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9703possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9704
9705 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009707All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9708criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9709method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9710to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9711criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9712the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009714If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009715the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9716For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009718 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9719 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9720 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9721 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009722
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009723
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009724The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9725types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9726combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9727brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9728default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009730 +-------------------------------------------------+
9731 | Input sample type |
9732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009733 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009734 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9735 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9736 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009737 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009738 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009739 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009740 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009741 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009742 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009743 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009744 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009745 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009746 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009747 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009749 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009750 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009751 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009752 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009753 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009754 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009755 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009756 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009757 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9759 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9760 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009761
9762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097637.1.1. Matching booleans
9764------------------------
9765
9766In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9767Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9768When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9769that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9770
9771Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9772return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9773"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9774
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097767.1.2. Matching integers
9777------------------------
9778
9779Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9780enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9781to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9782
9783Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9784matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9785lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009786
9787For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9788unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9789representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9790
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009791As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9792two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9793instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9794ranges and operators.
9795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009796For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009797operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9798Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9799of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009800
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009801Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009802
9803 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9804 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9805 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9806 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9807 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009809For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009810
9811 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9812
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009813This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9814
9815 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098187.1.3. Matching strings
9819-----------------------
9820
9821String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9822different forms :
9823
9824 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9825 patterns ;
9826
9827 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9828 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9829
9830 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9831 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9832
9833 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9834 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9835
9836 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9837 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9838 matches.
9839
9840 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9841 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9842 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009843
9844String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9845exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9846characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9847string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9848to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009849before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009850
9851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098527.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9853---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009854
9855Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9856they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9857possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9858passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9859the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009860the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9861match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009862
9863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098647.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9865-------------------------------------
9866
9867It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9868not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9869a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9870to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9871digits may be used upper or lower case.
9872
9873Example :
9874 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9875 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9876
9877
98787.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9879---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009880
9881IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9882netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9883within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009884host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009885difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9886at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9887does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9888parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009889
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009890IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9891Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9892trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9893IPv6 patterns.
9894
9895HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9896following situations :
9897 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9898 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9899 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9900 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9901 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9902 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9903 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9904 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9905 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9906 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908
99097.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9910----------------------------------
9911
9912Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9913combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9914
9915 - AND (implicit)
9916 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9917 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009919A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009921 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009923Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9924indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9927"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9928requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9929is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9930
9931 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9932 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9933 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9934 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9935
9936To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9937and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9938
9939 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9940 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9941 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9942 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9943
9944 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9945 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9946 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9947 use_backend www if host_www
9948
9949It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9950expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9951be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9952the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9953
9954 The following rule :
9955
9956 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9957 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9958
9959 Can also be written that way :
9960
9961 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9962
9963It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9964to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9965simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9966sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9967good use is the following :
9968
9969 With named ACLs :
9970
9971 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9972 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9973 monitor fail if site_dead
9974
9975 With anonymous ACLs :
9976
9977 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9978
9979See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9980
9981
99827.3. Fetching samples
9983---------------------
9984
9985Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9986against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9987sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9988ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9989of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9990available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9991
9992This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9993Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9994compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9995deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9996
9997The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9998matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9999method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10000indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10001
10002As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10003when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10004mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10005the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10006ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10007
10008Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10009multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10010when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10011incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10012are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10013is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10014all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10015
10016Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10017 - name
10018 - name(arg1)
10019 - name(arg1,arg2)
10020
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010021
100227.3.1. Converters
10023-----------------
10024
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010025Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10026of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10027is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10028was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10029has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10030unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10031
10032These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10033sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10034the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10035support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010037The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010038
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010039base64
10040 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10041 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10042 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10043
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010044bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10045 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10046 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10047 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10048
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010049djb2([<avalanche>])
10050 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10051 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10052 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10053 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10054 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10055 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10056 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10057 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10058 directive.
10059
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010060field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10061 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10062 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10063 list of chars.
10064
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010065hex
10066 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10067 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10068 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10069 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010070
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010071http_date([<offset>])
10072 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10073 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10074 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10075 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10076 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10077 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010078
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010079in_table(<table>)
10080 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10081 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10082 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10083 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10084 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10085
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010086ipmask(<mask>)
10087 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10088 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10089 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10090 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10091
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010092json([<input-code>])
10093 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10094 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10095 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10096 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10097 of errors:
10098 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10099 bytes, ...)
10100 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10101 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10102
10103 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10104 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10105 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10106 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10107 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10108 are :
10109 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10110 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10111 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10112 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10113 error ;
10114 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10115 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10116
10117 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10118 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10119
10120 Example:
10121 capture request header user-agent len 150
10122 capture request header Host len 15
10123 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10124
10125 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10126 GET / HTTP/1.0
10127 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10128
10129 Output log:
10130 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010132language(<value>[,<default>])
10133 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10134 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10135 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10136 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10137 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10138 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10139 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10140 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10141 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10142 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10143 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10144 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010145
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010146 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010147
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010148 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10149 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010150
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010151 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10152 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10153 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10154 use_backend spanish if es
10155 use_backend french if fr
10156 use_backend english if en
10157 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010158
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010159lower
10160 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10161 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10162 type. The result is of type string.
10163
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010164ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10165 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10166 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10167 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10168 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10169 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10170 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10171
10172 Example :
10173
10174 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10175 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10176 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10177
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010178map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10179map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10180map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10181 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10182 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10183 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10184 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10185 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10186 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10187 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10188 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010189
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010190 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10191 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10192 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010193
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010194 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10195 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010196
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010197 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10198 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10199 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10200 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010201 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10202 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010203 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10204 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10205 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10206 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10207 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10208 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10209 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10210 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10211 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10212 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10213 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10214 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10215 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10216 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010217
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010218 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10219 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10220 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10221 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10222 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010224 Example :
10225
10226 # this is a comment and is ignored
10227 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10228 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10229 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10230 | | | `---------- value
10231 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10232 | `---------------------------- key
10233 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10234
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010235sdbm([<avalanche>])
10236 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10237 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10238 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10239 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10240 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10241 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10242 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10243 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10244 directive.
10245
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010246table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10247 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10248 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10249 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10250 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10251 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10252 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10253
10254
10255table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10256 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10257 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10258 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10259 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10260 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10261 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10262
10263table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10264 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10265 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10266 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10267 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10268 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10269
10270table_conn_cur(<table>)
10271 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10272 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10273 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10274 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10275 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10276
10277table_conn_rate(<table>)
10278 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10279 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10280 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10281 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10282 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10283
10284table_gpc0(<table>)
10285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10287 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10288 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10289 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10290
10291table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10292 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10293 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10294 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10295 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10296 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10297 sample fetch keyword.
10298
10299table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10300 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10301 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10302 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10303 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10304 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10305
10306table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10307 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10308 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10309 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10310 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10311 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10312 keyword.
10313
10314table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10317 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10318 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10319 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10320
10321table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10322 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10323 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10324 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10325 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10326 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10327 keyword.
10328
10329table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10330 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10331 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10332 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10333 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10334 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10335 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10336 keyword.
10337
10338table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10339 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10340 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10341 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10342 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10343 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10344 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10345 keyword.
10346
10347table_server_id(<table>)
10348 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10349 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10350 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10351 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10352 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10353 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10354
10355table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10356 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10357 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10358 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10359 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10360 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10361 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10362 keyword.
10363
10364table_sess_rate(<table>)
10365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10367 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10368 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10369 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10370 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10371 keyword.
10372
10373table_trackers(<table>)
10374 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10375 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10376 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10377 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10378 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10379 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10380 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10381 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10382 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10383 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10384
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010385upper
10386 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10387 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10388 type. The result is of type string.
10389
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010390utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10391 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10392 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10393 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10394 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10395 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10396 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10397
10398 Example :
10399
10400 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10401 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10402 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10403
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010404word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10405 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10406 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10407
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010408wt6([<avalanche>])
10409 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10410 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10411 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10412 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10413 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10414 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10415 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10416 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "sdbm", and the "hash-type"
10417 directive.
10418
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010419
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104207.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010421--------------------------------------------
10422
10423A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10424not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10425"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10426The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10427
10428always_false : boolean
10429 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10430 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10431
10432always_true : boolean
10433 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10434 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10435
10436avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010437 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010438 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10439 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10440 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10441 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10442 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10443 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10444 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10445 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10446 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10447 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10448 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10449 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10450 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010453 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10454 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10455 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10456 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10457 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010459be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10461 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10462 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10463 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10464 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10465 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010466
10467 Example :
10468 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10469 backend dynamic
10470 mode http
10471 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10472 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010474connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10475 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010476 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010477 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10478 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010479
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010480 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010481 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010482 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10483
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010484 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10485 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010486
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010487 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010488 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010489 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010490 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10491 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010493 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010494
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010495 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10496 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010497 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010498 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010499
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010500date([<offset>]) : integer
10501 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10502 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10503 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10504 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010505 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10506
10507 Example :
10508
10509 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10510 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010511
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010512env(<name>) : string
10513 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10514 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10515 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10516 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10517 certain way.
10518
10519 Examples :
10520 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10521 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10522
10523 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10524 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10527 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010528 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10529 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010530 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10531 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10532 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10533 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10534 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10538 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10539 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10540 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10541 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10542 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10543 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10544 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010545
10546 Example :
10547 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10548 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10549 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10550 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10551 frontend mail
10552 bind :25
10553 mode tcp
10554 maxconn 100
10555 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10556 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10557 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10558 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010559
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010560nbproc : integer
10561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10562 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10563 and debugging purposes.
10564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010565nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10567 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10568 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010569 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10570 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10571 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010572
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010573proc : integer
10574 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10575 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10576 debugging purposes.
10577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010579 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10580 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10581 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010582 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10583 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10584 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10585 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10586 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10587
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010588rand([<range>]) : integer
10589 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10590 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10591 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10592 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10593 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010595srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10596 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10597 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10598 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10599 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10600 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10601 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10602 methods.
10603
10604srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10605 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10606 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10607 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10608 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10609 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10610 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10611 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10612
10613srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10614 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10615 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010616 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10618 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10619 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10620 overloading servers).
10621
10622 Example :
10623 # Redirect to a separate back
10624 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10625 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10626 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10627
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010628stopping : boolean
10629 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10630 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10631 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10634 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10635 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10636
10637table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10638 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10639 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10640 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10641
10642
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644----------------------------------
10645
10646The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10647closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10648methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10649sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10650TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010651the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10652counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10653"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010654argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10655the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10656this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657
10658be_id : integer
10659 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10660 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10661
10662dst : ip
10663 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10664 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10665 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10666 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10667 RFC 4291.
10668
10669dst_conn : integer
10670 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10671 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10672 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10673 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10674 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10675 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10676 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10677 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010679dst_port : integer
10680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10681 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10682 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10683 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10684 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10685 an HTTP header.
10686
10687fe_id : integer
10688 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10689 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10690 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010692sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010693sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10694sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10695sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010696 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10697 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10698 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10699
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010700sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010701sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10702sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10703sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010704 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10705 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10706 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10707
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010708sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010709sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10710sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10711sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010712 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10713 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010714 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10715 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10716 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010717
10718 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10719 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010720 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10721 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10722 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010723 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10724 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010726sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010727sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10728sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10729sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010730 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10731 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10732
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010733sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010734sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10735sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10736sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010737 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10738 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10739 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10740
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010741sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010742sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10743sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10744sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010745 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10746 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10747 See also src_conn_rate.
10748
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010749sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010750sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10751sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10752sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010753 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010754 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010756sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010757sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10758sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10759sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010760 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10761 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10762 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010763 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10764 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10765 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010766
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010767sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010768sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10769sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10770sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010771 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10772 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10773 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10774
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010775sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010776sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10777sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10778sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010779 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10780 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10781 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10782 src_http_err_rate.
10783
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010784sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010785sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10786sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10787sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010788 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10789 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10790 src_http_req_cnt.
10791
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010792sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010793sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10794sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10795sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010796 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10797 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10798 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10799 src_http_req_rate.
10800
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010801sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010802sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10803sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10804sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010805 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010806 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10807 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10808 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10809 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010810
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010811 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10812 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010813 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10814
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010815sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010816sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10817sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10818sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010819 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10820 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10821 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010822
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010823sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010824sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10825sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10826sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010827 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10828 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10829 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010830
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010831sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010832sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10833sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10834sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010835 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10836 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10837 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10838 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010839 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010840 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010842sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010843sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10844sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10845sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010846 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10847 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10848 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10849 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10850 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010851 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010853sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010854sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10855sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10856sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010857 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10858 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10859 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10860
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010861sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010862sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10863sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10864sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010865 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10866 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010867 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010868 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10869 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010870 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10871 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10872 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010874so_id : integer
10875 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10876 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10877 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879src : ip
10880 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10881 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10882 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10883 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10884 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10885 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10886 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010887
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010888 Example:
10889 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10890 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10893 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10894 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10895 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010896 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010898src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10899 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10900 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010901 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010902 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010904src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10905 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10906 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10907 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10908 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10909 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10910 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010911
10912 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10913 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10914 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10915 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010916 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010917 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10918 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010920src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010921 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010923 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010924 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010926src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010927 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10929 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010930 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010932src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10933 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10934 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10935 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010936 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010938src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010939 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010941 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010942 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010944src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010945 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010946 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010947 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10948 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010949 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10950 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10951 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010953src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10954 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10955 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010956 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010957 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010958 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010960src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10961 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10962 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10963 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10964 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010965 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010967src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10968 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10969 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10970 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010971 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010973src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10974 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10975 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10976 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010977 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010978 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10981 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10982 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10983 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010984 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010985 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10986 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010987
10988 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010989 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010990 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010993 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10994 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10995 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10996 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10997 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010999src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011000 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11001 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11002 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11003 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11004 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011006src_port : integer
11007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11008 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11009 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11010 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011012src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11013 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011014 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11015 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11016 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011017 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011019src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11020 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11021 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11022 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11023 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011024 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11027 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11028 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11029 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11030 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11031 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11032 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11033 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11034 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011035
11036 Example :
11037 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11038 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11039 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11040 listen ssh
11041 bind :22
11042 mode tcp
11043 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011044 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011045 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011046 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048srv_id : integer
11049 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11050 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11051 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011052
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011055----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11058closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11059when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11060usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011061future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011062
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011063ssl_bc : boolean
11064 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11065 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11066 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11067
11068ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11069 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11070 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11071
11072ssl_bc_cipher : string
11073 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11074 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11075
11076ssl_bc_protocol : string
11077 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11078 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11079
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011080ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011081 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011082 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11083 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011084
11085ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11086 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11087 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11088 if session was reused or not.
11089
11090ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11091 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11092 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11095 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11096 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11097 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11098 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11099 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011101ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11102 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11103 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11104 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11105 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011106
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011107ssl_c_der : binary
11108 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11109 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11110 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011112ssl_c_err : integer
11113 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11114 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11115 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11116 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11117 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011119ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11120 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11121 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11122 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11123 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11124 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11125 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11126 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11127 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011129ssl_c_key_alg : string
11130 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11131 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11132 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011134ssl_c_notafter : string
11135 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11136 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11137 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011139ssl_c_notbefore : string
11140 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11141 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11142 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011144ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11145 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11146 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11147 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11148 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11149 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11150 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11151 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11152 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011154ssl_c_serial : binary
11155 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11156 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11157 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011159ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11160 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11161 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11162 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011163 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11164 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11165
11166 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011168ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11169 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11170 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11171 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011173ssl_c_used : boolean
11174 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11175 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011177ssl_c_verify : integer
11178 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11179 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11180 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11181 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011183ssl_c_version : integer
11184 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11185 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011186
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011187ssl_f_der : binary
11188 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11189 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11190 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011192ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11193 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11194 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11195 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11196 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011197 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011198 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11199 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11200 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011202ssl_f_key_alg : string
11203 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11204 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11205 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011207ssl_f_notafter : string
11208 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11209 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11210 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212ssl_f_notbefore : string
11213 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11214 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11215 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011217ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11218 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11219 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11220 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11221 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11222 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11223 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11224 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11225 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227ssl_f_serial : binary
11228 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11229 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11230 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011231
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011232ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11233 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11234 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11235 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011237ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11238 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11239 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11240 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011242ssl_f_version : integer
11243 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11244 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11245
11246ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011247 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11248 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11249 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011251 Example :
11252 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11253 listen http-https
11254 bind :80
11255 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11256 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11257
11258ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11259 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11260 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11261
11262ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011263 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011264 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11265 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11266 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11267 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11268 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11269 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11270 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11271 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011273ssl_fc_cipher : string
11274 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11275 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011277ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011278 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11279 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011280 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11281 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11282 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11283 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011285ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11286 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011287 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11288 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11289 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11290 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011292ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011293 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11295 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11296 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11297 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11298 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11299 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11300 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011302ssl_fc_protocol : string
11303 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11304 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011305
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011306ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011307 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011308 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11309 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011311ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11312 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11313 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11314 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11315 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011317ssl_fc_sni : string
11318 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11319 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11320 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11321 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11322 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11323
11324 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11325 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11326 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011327 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11328 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11332 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011334ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11335 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11336 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011337
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113397.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011340------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11343sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11344only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11345For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11346be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11347can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11348sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11349for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11350content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11353 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11354 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11355 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011357payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11358 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11359 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11360 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011362req.len : integer
11363req_len : integer (deprecated)
11364 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11365 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11366 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11367 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11368 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11369 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11370 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11371 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011373req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11374 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011375 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11376 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11377 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11378 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011380 ACL alternatives :
11381 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011383req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11384 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11385 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11386 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11387 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011389 ACL alternatives :
11390 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394req.proto_http : boolean
11395req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11396 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11397 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11398 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11399 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11400 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11401 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11402 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011404 Example:
11405 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11406 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11407 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011408 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011410req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11411rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11412 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11413 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11414 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11415 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11416 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11417 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11418 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011420 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11421 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11422 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11423 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11424 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11425 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011427 ACL derivatives :
11428 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011430 Example :
11431 listen tse-farm
11432 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11433 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11434 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11435 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11436 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11437 persist rdp-cookie
11438 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11439 # This is only useful makes sense if
11440 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11441 stick-table type string size 204800
11442 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11443 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11444 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11447 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011449req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11450rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11451 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11452 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11453 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11454 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011456 ACL derivatives :
11457 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011459req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11460req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11461 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11462 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11463 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11464 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11465 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11466 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11467 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011469req.ssl_sni : string
11470req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11471 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11472 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11473 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11474 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11475 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11476 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11477 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11478 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11479 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11480 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11481 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11482 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484 ACL derivatives :
11485 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011487 Examples :
11488 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11489 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11490 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11491 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11492 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011494res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11495rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11496 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11497 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11498 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11499 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11500 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11501 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11502 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011504req.ssl_ver : integer
11505req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11506 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11507 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11508 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11509 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11510 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11511 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11512 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11513 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11514 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011516 ACL derivatives :
11517 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011518
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011519res.len : integer
11520 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11521 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11522 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11523 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11524 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11525 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11526 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11527 content inspection.
11528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011529res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11530 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011531 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11532 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11533 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11534 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011536res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11537 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11538 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11539 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11540 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011542 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011544wait_end : boolean
11545 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11546 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11547 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11548 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11549 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11550 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11551 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11552 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011554 Examples :
11555 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11556 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11557 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011559 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11560 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11561 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11562 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11563 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11564 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11565 tcp-request content reject
11566
11567
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115687.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011569--------------------------------------
11570
11571It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11572This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11573data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11574its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11575HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11576content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11577to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11578more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11579response are indexed.
11580
11581base : string
11582 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11583 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11584 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11585 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11586 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11587 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11588 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11589 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11590
11591 ACL derivatives :
11592 base : exact string match
11593 base_beg : prefix match
11594 base_dir : subdir match
11595 base_dom : domain match
11596 base_end : suffix match
11597 base_len : length match
11598 base_reg : regex match
11599 base_sub : substring match
11600
11601base32 : integer
11602 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11603 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11604 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011605 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11606 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11607 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011608
11609base32+src : binary
11610 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11611 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11612 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11613 per-URL counters.
11614
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011615capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11616 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11617 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11618 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11619
11620capture.req.method : string
11621 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11622 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11623 because it's allocated.
11624
11625capture.req.uri : string
11626 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11627 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11628 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11629 allocated.
11630
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011631capture.req.ver : string
11632 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11633 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11634 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11635
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011636capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11637 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11638 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11639 The first entry is an index of 0.
11640 See also: "capture response header"
11641
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011642capture.res.ver : string
11643 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11644 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11645 persistent flag.
11646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011647req.cook([<name>]) : string
11648cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11649 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11650 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11651 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11652 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11653 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11654 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11655 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11656 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11657
11658 ACL derivatives :
11659 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11660 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11661 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11662 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11663 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11664 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11665 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11666 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011668req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11669cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11670 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11671 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011673req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11674cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11675 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11676 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11677 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11678 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011680cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11681 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11682 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11683 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11684 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11685 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11686 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11687 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11688 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11689 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11690 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11693 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11694 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11695 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11696 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011697 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11700 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11701 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11702 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11703 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11704 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11705 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11706 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11707 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011709req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11710 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11711 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11712 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11713 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011715req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11716 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11717 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11718 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11719 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11720 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11721 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11722 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11723 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11724 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11725 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11726 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011728 ACL derivatives :
11729 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11730 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11731 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11732 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11733 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11734 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11735 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11736 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11737
11738req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11739hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11740 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11741 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11742 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11743 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11744 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11745 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11746 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11747 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11748 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11749
11750req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11751hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11752 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11753 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11754 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11755 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11756 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11757 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11758 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11759 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11760
11761req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11762hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11763 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11764 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11765 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11766 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11767 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11768 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11769 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11770
11771http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11772 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11773 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11774 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11775 basic auth is supported.
11776
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011777http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11778 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11779 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11780 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11781 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011782 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11783 basic auth is supported.
11784
11785 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011786 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11787 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11788 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11789 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011790
11791http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011792 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11793 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011794 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11795 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011797method : integer + string
11798 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11799 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11800 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11801 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11802 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11803 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11804 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806 ACL derivatives :
11807 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011809 Example :
11810 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11811 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11812 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011814path : string
11815 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11816 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11817 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11818 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11819 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11820 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11821 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011823 ACL derivatives :
11824 path : exact string match
11825 path_beg : prefix match
11826 path_dir : subdir match
11827 path_dom : domain match
11828 path_end : suffix match
11829 path_len : length match
11830 path_reg : regex match
11831 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833req.ver : string
11834req_ver : string (deprecated)
11835 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11836 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11837 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011839 ACL derivatives :
11840 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011842res.comp : boolean
11843 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11844 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11845 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847res.comp_algo : string
11848 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11849 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11850 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011852res.cook([<name>]) : string
11853scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11854 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11855 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11856 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011858 ACL derivatives :
11859 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011861res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11862scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11863 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11864 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11865 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011867res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11868scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11869 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11870 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11871 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011873res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11874 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11875 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11876 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11877 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11878 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11879 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11880 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11881 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11882 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011884res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11885 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11886 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11887 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11888 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11889 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011891res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11892shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11893 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11894 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11895 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11896 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11897 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11898 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11899 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11900 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011902 ACL derivatives :
11903 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11904 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11905 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11906 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11907 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11908 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11909 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11910 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11911
11912res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11913shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11914 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11915 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11916 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11917 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11918 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011920res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11921shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11922 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11923 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11924 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11925 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11926 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11927 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011929res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11930shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11931 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11932 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11933 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11934 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11935 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11936 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938res.ver : string
11939resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11940 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11941 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011943 ACL derivatives :
11944 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11947 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11948 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11949 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11950 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011952 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11953 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011955 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011957status : integer
11958 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11959 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11960 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011962url : string
11963 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11964 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11965 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11966 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11967 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11968 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11969 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011971 ACL derivatives :
11972 url : exact string match
11973 url_beg : prefix match
11974 url_dir : subdir match
11975 url_dom : domain match
11976 url_end : suffix match
11977 url_len : length match
11978 url_reg : regex match
11979 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011981url_ip : ip
11982 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11983 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11984 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11985 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11986 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11987 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11988 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011990url_port : integer
11991 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11992 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11993 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11994 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011996urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11997url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11998 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11999 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12000 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12001 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12002 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12003 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12004 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12005 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12006 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012008 ACL derivatives :
12009 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12010 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12011 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12012 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12013 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12014 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12015 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12016 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012017
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012019 Example :
12020 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12021 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12022 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12023 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12026 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12027 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12028 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012029
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120317.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012032---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012034Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12035every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012036order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012038ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12039---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012040FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012041HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012042HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12043HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012044HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12045HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12046HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12047HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12048LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012049METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12050METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12051METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12052METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12053METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12054METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012055RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012056REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012057TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012058WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12059---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012060
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120628. Logging
12063----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012065One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12066provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12067very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12068provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12069state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012070to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012071headers.
12072
12073In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12074about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12075send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12076
12077 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12078 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12079 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12080 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12081 at the termination.
12082
12083The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12084allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12085as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12086while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12087real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12088delay.
12089
12090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120918.1. Log levels
12092---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012093
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012094TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012095source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012096HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12097in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12098track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12099syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12100about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012101
12102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121038.2. Log formats
12104----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012105
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012106HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012107and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12108slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12109options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012110
12111 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12112 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12113 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12114 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12115 extents.
12116
12117 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12118 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12119 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12120 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12121 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12122
12123 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12124 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12125 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12126 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12127 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12128
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012129 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12130 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12131 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12132 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12133
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012134 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12135
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012136Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12137specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12138field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12139servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12140always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12141identifier.
12142
12143Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12144 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12145 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12146 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12147 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12148
12149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121508.2.1. Default log format
12151-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012152
12153This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12154as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12155format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12156
12157 Example :
12158 listen www
12159 mode http
12160 log global
12161 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12162
12163 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12164 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12165 (www/HTTP)
12166
12167 Field Format Extract from the example above
12168 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12169 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12170 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12171 4 'to' to
12172 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12173 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12174
12175Detailed fields description :
12176 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12177 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12178 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12179 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12180 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12181 and processed the connection.
12182 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12183
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012184In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12185"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12186connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012188It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12189will eventually disappear.
12190
12191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121928.2.2. TCP log format
12193---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012194
12195The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12196is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12197information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12198counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12199emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12200environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12201the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12202sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012203specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12204not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12205fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12206marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012207
12208 Example :
12209 frontend fnt
12210 mode tcp
12211 option tcplog
12212 log global
12213 default_backend bck
12214
12215 backend bck
12216 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12217
12218 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12219 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12220 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12221
12222 Field Format Extract from the example above
12223 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12224 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12225 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12226 4 frontend_name fnt
12227 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12228 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12229 7 bytes_read* 212
12230 8 termination_state --
12231 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12232 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12233
12234Detailed fields description :
12235 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012236 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12237 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12238 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12239 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12240 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012241
12242 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012243 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12244 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12245 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012246
12247 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12248 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12249 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12250 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12251
12252 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12253 and processed the connection.
12254
12255 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12256 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12257 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12258 applications.
12259
12260 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12261 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12262 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12263 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12264 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12265
12266 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12267 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12268 See "Timers" below for more details.
12269
12270 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12271 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12272 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12273 "Timers" below for more details.
12274
12275 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012276 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012277 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12278 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12279 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12280 details.
12281
12282 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12283 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12284 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12285 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12286 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12287
12288 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12289 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12290 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12291 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12292 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12293 for more details.
12294
12295 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012296 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012297 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12298 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12299 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012300 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012301
12302 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12303 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12304 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12305 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12306 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12307 caused by a denial of service attack.
12308
12309 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12310 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12311 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12312 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12313 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12314 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12315 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12316 denial of service attack.
12317
12318 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12319 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12320 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12321 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12322 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12323 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12324 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12325 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12326 be processed than on other servers.
12327
12328 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12329 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12330 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12331 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12332 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12333 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12334 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12335 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12336 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12337 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12338 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12339 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12340 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12341
12342 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12343 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12344 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12345 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12346 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12347 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12348 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12349 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12350
12351 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12352 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12353 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12354 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12355 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12356 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12357 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12358 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12359 occurs.
12360
12361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123628.2.3. HTTP log format
12363----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012364
12365The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12366is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12367the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12368are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12369emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12370generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12371"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12372which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012373frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12374is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012375
12376Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12377slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12378with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12379
12380 Example :
12381 frontend http-in
12382 mode http
12383 option httplog
12384 log global
12385 default_backend bck
12386
12387 backend static
12388 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12389
12390 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12391 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12392 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012393 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012394
12395 Field Format Extract from the example above
12396 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12397 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12398 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12399 4 frontend_name http-in
12400 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12401 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12402 7 status_code 200
12403 8 bytes_read* 2750
12404 9 captured_request_cookie -
12405 10 captured_response_cookie -
12406 11 termination_state ----
12407 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12408 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12409 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12410 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12411 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012412
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012413
12414Detailed fields description :
12415 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012416 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12417 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12418 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12419 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12420 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012421
12422 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012423 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12424 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12425 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012426
12427 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12428 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12429 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12430 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12431 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12432
12433 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12434 and processed the connection.
12435
12436 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12437 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12438 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12439
12440 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12441 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12442 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12443 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12444 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12445 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12446
12447 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12448 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12449 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12450 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12451 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12452 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12453
12454 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12455 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12456 See "Timers" below for more details.
12457
12458 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12459 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12460 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12461 below for more details.
12462
12463 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12464 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12465 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12466 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12467 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12468 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12469 for more details.
12470
12471 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012472 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012473 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12474 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12475 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12476 details.
12477
12478 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12479 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12480 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12481
12482 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12483 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12484 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12485 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12486 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12487 overflowing.
12488
12489 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12490 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12491 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12492 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12493 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12494 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12495 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12496 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12497
12498 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12499 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12500 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12501 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12502 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12503 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12504 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12505 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12506
12507 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12508 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12509 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12510 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12511 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12512 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12513 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12514
12515 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012516 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012517 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12518 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12519 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012520 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012521 system.
12522
12523 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12524 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12525 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12526 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12527 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12528 caused by a denial of service attack.
12529
12530 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12531 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12532 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12533 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12534 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12535 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12536 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12537 denial of service attack.
12538
12539 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12540 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12541 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12542 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12543 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12544 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12545 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12546 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12547 processed than on other servers.
12548
12549 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12550 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12551 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12552 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12553 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12554 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12555 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12556 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12557 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12558 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12559 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12560 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12561 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12562
12563 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12564 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12565 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12566 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12567 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12568 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12569 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12570 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12571
12572 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12573 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12574 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12575 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12576 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12577 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12578 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12579 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12580 occurs.
12581
12582 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12583 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12584 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12585 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12586 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12587 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12588 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12589 cookies" below for more details.
12590
12591 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12592 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12593 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12594 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12595 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12596 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12597 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12598 and cookies" below for more details.
12599
12600 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12601 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12602 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12603 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12604 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12605 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12606 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12607 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12608
12609
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200126108.2.4. Custom log format
12611------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012612
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012613The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012614mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012615
12616HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12617Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12618separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12619prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12620
12621Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12622variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12623string formats ("Q").
12624
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012625If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012626as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012627less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12628the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12629
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012630Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012631In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012632in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012633
12634Flags are :
12635 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012636 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012637
12638 Example:
12639
12640 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12641 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12642
12643At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12644
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012645 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12646 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012647
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012648the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012649
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012650 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012651 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012652 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012653
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012654and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12655
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012656 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012657 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12658
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012659Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12660
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012661 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012662 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012663 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12664 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12665 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012666 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12667 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12668 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012669 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012670 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012671 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012672 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012673 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012674 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012675 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12676 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012677 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012678 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12679 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012680 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012681 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12682 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012683 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12684 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12685 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012686 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012687 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12688 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012689 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012690 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12691 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12692 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012693 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020012694 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012695 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12696 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12697 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12698 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012699 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012700 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012701 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012702 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012703 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012704 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012705 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12706 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12707 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012708 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012709 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12710 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012711 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012712 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012713 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012714 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012715
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012716 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012717
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012718
127198.2.5. Error log format
12720-----------------------
12721
12722When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12723protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12724By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12725"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12726will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12727logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12728
12729The format looks like this :
12730
12731 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12732 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12733 Connection error during SSL handshake
12734
12735 Field Format Extract from the example above
12736 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12737 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12738 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12739 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12740 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12741
12742These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12743failures.
12744
12745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127468.3. Advanced logging options
12747-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012748
12749Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12750just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12751options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12752for more information about their usage.
12753
12754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127558.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12756------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012757
12758It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12759haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12760commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12761monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12762ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12763
12764 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12765 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12766 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12767 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12768
12769 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12770 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12771 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012772 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012773 such as other load-balancers.
12774
12775 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12776 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12777 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12778
12779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12781----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012782
12783The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12784what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12785or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12786"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12787just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12788log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12789after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12790is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12791with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12792with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12793
12794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127958.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12796------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012797
12798Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12799for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12800"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12801retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12802raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12803a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12804file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12805you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12806"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12807
12808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12810--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012811
12812Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12813multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12814them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12815"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12816logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12817error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12818and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12819too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12820useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12821alternative.
12822
12823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128248.4. Timing events
12825------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012826
12827Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12828reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12829the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12830frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12831mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12832
12833 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12834 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12835 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12836 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12837 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12838
12839 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12840 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12841 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12842 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12843 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12844
12845 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12846 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12847 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12848 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12849 connection never established.
12850
12851 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12852 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12853 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12854 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12855 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12856 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12857 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12858 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12859 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12860 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12861 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12862
12863 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12864 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12865 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12866 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012867 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012868
12869 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12870
12871 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12872 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12873 negative.
12874
12875These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12876protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12877that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012878due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012879close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12880session has been aborted on timeout.
12881
12882Most common cases :
12883
12884 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12885 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12886 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12887 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12888 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12889 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12890 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12891 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12892 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012893 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12894 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12895 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012896
12897 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12898 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12899 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12900 of ms on remote networks.
12901
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012902 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12903 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12904 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012905
12906 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12907 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12908 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12909 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12910 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12911 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12912 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12913 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12914 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12915 to the server until another one is released.
12916
12917Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12918
12919 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12920 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12921 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12922
12923 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12924 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12925 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12926
12927 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12928 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12929 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12930 flags.
12931
12932 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12933 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12934 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12935 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12936 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12937 the client connection was maintained open.
12938
12939 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012940 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012941 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12942 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12943
12944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129458.5. Session state at disconnection
12946-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012947
12948TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12949"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
129502-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12951each of which has a special meaning :
12952
12953 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12954 session to terminate :
12955
12956 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12957
12958 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12959 server explicitly refused it.
12960
12961 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12962 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12963 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12964 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012965 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12966
12967 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12968 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012969
12970 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12971 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12972 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12973 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12974 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12975
12976 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12977 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12978 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12979 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12980 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12981
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012982 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12983 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12984
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012985 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12986 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12987 backup connections when going up.
12988
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012989 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12990
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012991 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12992 send or receive data.
12993
12994 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12995 send or receive data.
12996
12997 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12998 with nothing left in the buffers.
12999
13000 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13001
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013002 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013003 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13004
13005 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13006 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13007 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13008 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13009 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13010
13011 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13012 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13013
13014 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13015 server (HTTP only).
13016
13017 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13018
13019 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13020 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13021 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13022
13023 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13024 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13025 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13026
13027 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13028
13029 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13030 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13031
13032 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13033 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13034 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13035
13036 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13037 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013038 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13039 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013040
13041 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13042 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13043 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13044 another server.
13045
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013046 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013047 server.
13048
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013049 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13050 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13051 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13052 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13053
13054 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13055 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13056 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13057 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13058
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013059 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13060 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13061 "use-server" rule).
13062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013063 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13064
13065 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13066 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13067
13068 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13069
13070 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13071 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13072 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13073
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013074 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13075 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013076 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013077 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13078 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013080 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13081
13082 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13083 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13084
13085 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13086
13087 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13088
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013089The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13090was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013091helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13092starvation, attacks, etc...
13093
13094The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13095alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13096easier finding and understanding.
13097
13098 Flags Reason
13099
13100 -- Normal termination.
13101
13102 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13103 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13104 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13105 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13106
13107 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13108 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13109 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13110 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13111 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13112 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013113
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013114 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13115 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013116 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013117
13118 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13119 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13120 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13121
13122 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13123 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13124 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13125 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13126 the server takes too long to respond.
13127
13128 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13129 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13130 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13131 long a time to respond.
13132
13133 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13134 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13135 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13136 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13137 and the client.
13138
13139 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13140 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13141 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13142 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13143 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013144 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13145 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13146 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13147 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13148 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13149 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13150 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13151 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13152 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13153 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13154 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13155 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13156 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13157 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013158
13159 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13160 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013161 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13162 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13163 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13164 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013165
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013166 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13167 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013169 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013170 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13171 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13172 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13173 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13174 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13175
13176 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13177 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13178 503 or 504 here.
13179
13180 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13181 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13182 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13183 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13184 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13185
13186 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13187 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013188 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013189 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13190 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13191
13192 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13193 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13194 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13195 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13196 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13197 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13198 between haproxy and the server.
13199
13200 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13201 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13202 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13203 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13204 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13205 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13206 solution is to fix the application.
13207
13208 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13209 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13210 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13211 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13212 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13213 external attacks.
13214
13215 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13216 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013217 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013218 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13219 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13220
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013221 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13222 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13223 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013224 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13225 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013226
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013227 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13228 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13229 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13230 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013231 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13232 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13233 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13234 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13235 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013236
13237 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13238 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13239 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13240 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13241
13242 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13243 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13244 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13245 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13246
13247 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13248 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13249 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13250 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13251
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013252The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13253persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13254important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13255re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13256
13257 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13258
13259 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13260 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13261 set on a GET request.
13262
13263 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13264 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013265 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013266 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13267
13268 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13269 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13270 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13271
13272 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13273 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13274 already got a cookie.
13275
13276 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13277 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13278 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13279 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13280 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13281
13282 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13283 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13284 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13285
13286 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13287 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13288 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13289
13290 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13291 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13292
13293 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13294 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13295 then advertised in the response.
13296
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132988.6. Non-printable characters
13299-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013300
13301In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13302consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13303converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13304prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13305being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13306escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13307is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13308'}' when logging headers.
13309
13310Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13311issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13312containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13313
13314Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13315the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13316performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13317
13318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133198.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13320---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013321
13322Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13323achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013324section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013325cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13326the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13327the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013328locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013329not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13330user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13331a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13332wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13333
13334 Examples :
13335 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13336 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13337
13338 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13339 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13340
13341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133428.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13343---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013344
13345Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13346proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13347the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13348server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13349
13350Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13351response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013352section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013353
13354It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013355time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13356appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013357are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13358and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13359follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13360request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13361in the logs.
13362
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013363As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13364frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13365an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13366
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013367 Example :
13368 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13369 listen proxy-out
13370 mode http
13371 option httplog
13372 option logasap
13373 log global
13374 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13375
13376 # log the name of the virtual server
13377 capture request header Host len 20
13378
13379 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13380 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13381
13382 # log the beginning of the referrer
13383 capture request header Referer len 20
13384
13385 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13386 capture response header Server len 20
13387
13388 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13389 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13390
13391 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13392 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13393
13394 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13395 capture response header Via len 20
13396
13397 # log the URL location during a redirection
13398 capture response header Location len 20
13399
13400 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13401 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13402 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13403 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13404 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13405
13406 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13407 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13408 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13409 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013410 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013411
13412 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13413 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13414 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13415 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13416 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013417 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013418
13419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134208.9. Examples of logs
13421---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013422
13423These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13424them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13425reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13426
13427 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13428 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13429 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13430
13431 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13432 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13433
13434 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13435 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13436 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13437
13438 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13439 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13440
13441 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13442 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13443 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13444
13445 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013446 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013447 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13448 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13449
13450 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13451 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13452 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13453
13454 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13455 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013456 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013457 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13458 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13459 to return the 502 and not the server.
13460
13461 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013462 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013463
13464 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13465 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13466 Nothing was sent to any server.
13467
13468 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13469 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13470
13471 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13472 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13473 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13474 send a 408 return code to the client.
13475
13476 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13477 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13478
13479 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13480 5 seconds ("c----").
13481
13482 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13483 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013484 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013485
13486 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013487 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013488 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13489 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13490 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13491 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13492 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013493
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134959. Statistics and monitoring
13496----------------------------
13497
13498It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13499mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13500CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13501Unix socket.
13502
13503
135049.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013505---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013506
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013507The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013508page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13509begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13510represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13511use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13512('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13513(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13514text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13515do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13516use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013517
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013518In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13519that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13520S (Servers).
13521
13522 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13523 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13524 any name for server/listener)
13525 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13526 number queued without a server assigned.
13527 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13528 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13529 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13530 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13531 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13532 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13533 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13534 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13535 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13536 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13537 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13538 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13539 "option checkcache".
13540 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13541 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13542 - read error from the client
13543 - client timeout
13544 - client closed connection
13545 - various bad requests from the client.
13546 - request was tarpitted.
13547 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13548 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13549 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13550 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13551 active servers).
13552 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13553 Some other errors are:
13554 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13555 - failure applying filters to the response.
13556 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13557 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13558 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13559 switched away from.
13560 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13561 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13562 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13563 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13564 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13565 the server is up.)
13566 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13567 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13568 counters for each server.
13569 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13570 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13571 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13572 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13573 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13574 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13575 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13576 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13577 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13578 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13579 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13580 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13581 of times that server was selected.
13582 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13583 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13584 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13585 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13586 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13587 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013588 UNK -> unknown
13589 INI -> initializing
13590 SOCKERR -> socket error
13591 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13592 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13593 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13594 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13595 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13596 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13597 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13598 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13599 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13600 disable-on-404
13601 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13602 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13603 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013604 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13605 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13606 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13607 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13608 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13609 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13610 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13611 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13612 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13613 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13614 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13615 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13616 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13617 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13618 (inc. in eresp)
13619 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13620 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13621 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13622 (CPU/BW limit)
13623 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13624 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13625 server/backend
13626 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13627 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13628 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13629 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13630 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13631 (0 for TCP)
13632 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13633 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013634
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136369.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013637-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013638
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013639The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13640necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13641A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13642issuing commands by hand :
13643
13644 global
13645 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13646 stats timeout 2m
13647
13648It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13649the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13650never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13651situations :
13652
13653 global
13654 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13655 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13656 stats timeout 2m
13657
13658To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13659swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13660to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13661syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13662
13663 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13664 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13665
13666The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13667script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13668for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13669
13670The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13671that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13672editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13673(eg: watch a counter).
13674
13675The socket supports two operation modes :
13676 - interactive
13677 - non-interactive
13678
13679The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13680this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13681sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13682mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13683commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13684example :
13685
13686 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13687
13688The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13689entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13690for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13691sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13692"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13693after processing the last command of the same line.
13694
13695For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13696"prompt" command :
13697
13698 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13699 prompt
13700 > show info
13701 ...
13702 >
13703
13704Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13705delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13706that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13707parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013708
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013709It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13710on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13711own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013712
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013713The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13714If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13715all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13716it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13717
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013718add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013719 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13720 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13721 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13722 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013723
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013724add map <map> <key> <value>
13725 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13726 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013727 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13728 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13729 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013730
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013731clear counters
13732 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13733 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13734 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13735 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13736 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13737
13738clear counters all
13739 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13740 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13741 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13742
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013743clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013744 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13745 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13746 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013747
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013748clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013749 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13750 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13751 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013752
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013753clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13754 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13755
13756 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13757 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13758 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13759 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13760 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13761 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13762
13763 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13764
13765 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13766 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13767 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13768 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13769 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13770 the ACLs :
13771
13772 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13773 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13774 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13775 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13776 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13777 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13778
13779 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013780 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13781 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013782
13783 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013784 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013785 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013786 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13787 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13788 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13789 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013790
13791 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13792
13793 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013794 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013795 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13796 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013797 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13798 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13799 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013800
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013801del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13802 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013803 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13804 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13805 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13806 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013807
13808del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013809 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013810 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13811 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13812 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13813 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013814
13815disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013816 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13817
13818 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13819 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13820 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13821 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13822 re-enabled using enable agent.
13823
13824 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13825 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13826 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13827 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13828 otherwise unchanged.
13829
13830 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13831 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13832 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13833
13834 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13835 level "admin".
13836
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013837disable frontend <frontend>
13838 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13839 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13840 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13841 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13842 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13843 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13844 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13845 on the stats page.
13846
13847 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13848 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13849
13850 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13851 level "admin".
13852
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013853disable health <backend>/<server>
13854 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13855 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13856 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13857 agent check forces it down.
13858
13859 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13860 level "admin".
13861
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013862disable server <backend>/<server>
13863 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13864 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13865 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13866 during the maintenance.
13867
13868 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13869 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13870
13871 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013872 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013873
13874 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13875 level "admin".
13876
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013877enable agent <backend>/<server>
13878 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13879
13880 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13881 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13882
13883 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13884 level "admin".
13885
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013886enable frontend <frontend>
13887 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13888 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13889 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13890 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13891 which was disabled.
13892
13893 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13894 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13895
13896 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13897 level "admin".
13898
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013899enable health <backend>/<server>
13900 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13901 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13902
13903 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13904 level "admin".
13905
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013906enable server <backend>/<server>
13907 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13908 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13909
13910 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013911 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013912
13913 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13914 level "admin".
13915
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013916get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013917get acl <acl> <value>
13918 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13919 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13920 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13921 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13922 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013923
13924 The first two words are:
13925
13926 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13927 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13928 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13929
13930 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13931
13932 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13933
13934 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13935
13936 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13937 interpretation of the case.
13938
13939 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13940 useful with regular expressions.
13941
13942 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13943 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13944
13945 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13946 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13947 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13948
13949 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13950
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013951get weight <backend>/<server>
13952 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13953 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13954 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13955 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13956 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013957 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013958
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013959help
13960 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13961 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013962
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013963prompt
13964 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13965 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13966 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13967 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13968 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13969 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13970 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13971 command.
13972
13973quit
13974 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013975
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013976set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013977 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13978 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13979 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013980
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013981set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013982 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13983 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13984 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13985 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13986 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013987 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13988 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13989
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013990set maxconn global <maxconn>
13991 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13992 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13993 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13994 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13995 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13996 setting.
13997
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013998set rate-limit connections global <value>
13999 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14000 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14001 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14002 is passed in number of connections per second.
14003
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014004set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14005 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14006 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014007 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14008 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014009
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014010set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14011 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14012 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14013 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14014 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14015
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014016set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14017 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14018 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14019 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14020 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14021 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14022
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014023set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14024 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14025 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14026 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14027
14028set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14029 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14030 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14031 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14032
14033set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14034 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14035 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14036 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14037 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14038 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14039 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14040 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14041 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14042
14043set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14044 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14045 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14046
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014047set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14048 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14049 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14050 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14051 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14052
14053 Example:
14054 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14055 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14056 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14057 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14058
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014059set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014060 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14061 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14062 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14063 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014064 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14065 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014066
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014067set timeout cli <delay>
14068 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14069 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14070 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14071
14072set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14073 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14074 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014075 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14076 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14077 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14078 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14079 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14080 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14081 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14082 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14083 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14084 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14085 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14086 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14087 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014088
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014089show errors [<iid>]
14090 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14091 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014092 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14093 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14094 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014095
14096 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14097 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14098 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14099 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14100 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14101 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14102 are reported too.
14103
14104 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14105 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14106 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14107 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14108 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14109 code.
14110
14111 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14112 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14113 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14114 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14115 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14116 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14117 line.
14118
14119 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014120 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14121 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014122 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14123 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14124
14125 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14126 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14127 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14128 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14129 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14130 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14131 00204+ minal\r\n
14132 00211 \r\n
14133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014134 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014135 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14136 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14137 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14138 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14139 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14140 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014141
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014142show info
14143 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14144
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014145show map [<map>]
14146 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014147 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14148 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14149 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14150 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14151 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14152 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014153
14154show acl [<acl>]
14155 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014156 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14157 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14158 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14159 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14160 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014161
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014162show pools
14163 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14164 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14165 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14166 the pools.
14167
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014168show sess
14169 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014170 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14171 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14172
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014173show sess <id>
14174 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14175 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14176 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14177 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14178 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014179 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14180 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14181
14182 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14183 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014184
14185show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14186 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14187 possible to dump only selected items :
14188 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14189 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14190 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14191 for example:
14192 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14193 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14194 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14195
14196 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014197 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14198 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014199 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14200 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14201 Nbproc: 1
14202 Process_num: 1
14203 (...)
14204
14205 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14206 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14207 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14208 (...)
14209 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14210
14211 $
14212
14213 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14214 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14215 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14216 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014217 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014218
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014219show table
14220 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14221 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14222 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14223 entries currently in use.
14224
14225 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014226 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014227 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14228 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014229
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014230show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014231 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14232 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14233 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014234 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14235
14236 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14237 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14238 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14239 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14240 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14241
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014242 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14243 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14244 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14245 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14246 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14247 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14248
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014249
14250 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014251 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14252 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014253
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014254 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014255 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014256 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014257 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14258 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14259 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14260 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014261
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014262 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014263 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014264 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14265 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014266
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014267 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14268 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014269 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014270 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14271 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014272
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014273 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14274 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014275 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014276 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14277 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14278
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014279 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14280 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14281 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14282 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14283 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14284
14285 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14286 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14287 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014288 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14289 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014290 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14291 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014292
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014293shutdown frontend <frontend>
14294 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14295 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14296 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14297 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14298 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14299 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14300 once it is terminated.
14301
14302 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14303 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14304
14305 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14306 level "admin".
14307
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014308shutdown session <id>
14309 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14310 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14311 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14312 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14313 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14314 flag in the logs.
14315
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014316shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014317 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14318 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14319 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14320 'K' flag in the logs.
14321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014322/*
14323 * Local variables:
14324 * fill-column: 79
14325 * End:
14326 */